blob: 88fe71ab97edf02fac7a40da1472b76965adff18 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200459 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200460 - noepoll
461 - nokqueue
462 - nopoll
463 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200468 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100469 - tune.maxaccept
470 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200471 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200472 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100473 - tune.rcvbuf.client
474 - tune.rcvbuf.server
475 - tune.sndbuf.client
476 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100477
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478 * Debugging
479 - debug
480 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481
482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004833.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484------------------------------------
485
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200486ca-base <dir>
487 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200488 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
489 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491chroot <jail dir>
492 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
493 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
494 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
495 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
496 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
497 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200499crt-base <dir>
500 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
501 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
502 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504daemon
505 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
506 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
507 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
508
509gid <number>
510 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
511 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
512 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
513 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515group <group name>
516 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
517 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100518
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200519log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
521 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100522 configured with "log global".
523
524 <address> can be one of:
525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100526 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100527 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
528 port).
529
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100530 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
531 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
532 port).
533
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100534 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
535 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
536 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
537 writeable).
538
539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
544
545 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200546 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
547 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
548 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
549 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
550 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
551 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200553 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100555log-send-hostname [<string>]
556 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
557 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
558 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
559 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
560 the logs.
561
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000562log-tag <string>
563 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
564 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
565 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
566 running on the same host.
567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568nbproc <number>
569 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
570 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
571 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
572 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
573 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
574
575pidfile <pidfile>
576 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
577 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
578 starting the process. See also "daemon".
579
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200580stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
581 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
582 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
583 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
584 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
585 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
586 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
587 the number of processes used.
588
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200589stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
590 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
591 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
592 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
593 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200594
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200595 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
596 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
597 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
600 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
601 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100602 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603
604stats maxconn <connections>
605 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
606 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608uid <number>
609 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
610 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
611 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
612 one. See also "gid" and "user".
613
614ulimit-n <number>
615 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
616 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
617 option.
618
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100619unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
620 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
621
622 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
623 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
624 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
625 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
626 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
627 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
628 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
629 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
630 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
631 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633user <user name>
634 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
635 See also "uid" and "group".
636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200637node <name>
638 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
639
640 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
641 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
642 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
643 traffic.
644
645description <text>
646 Add a text that describes the instance.
647
648 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
649 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
650 "<" and ">" characters.
651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006533.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654-----------------------
655
656maxconn <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
658 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
659 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
660 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
661
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200662maxconnrate <number>
663 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
664 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
665 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
666 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
667 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
668 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
669 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
670 fairness.
671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100672maxpipes <number>
673 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
674 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
675 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
676 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
677 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
678 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
679
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200680maxsslconn <number>
681 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
682 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
683 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
684 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
685 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
686 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
687 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689noepoll
690 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
691 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
692 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
693
694nokqueue
695 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
696 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
697 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
698
699nopoll
700 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
701 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100702 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
704 "nokqueue".
705
706nosepoll
707 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
708 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
709 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
710
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100711nosplice
712 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
713 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
714 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100715 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100716 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
717 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
718 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
719 "option splice-response".
720
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200721spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
722 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
723 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
724 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
725 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
726 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
727
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200728tune.bufsize <number>
729 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
730 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
731 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
732 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
733 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
734 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
735 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
736 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400737 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
738 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
739 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200740
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200741tune.chksize <number>
742 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
743 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
744 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
745 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
746 checks whenever possible.
747
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200748tune.http.maxhdr <number>
749 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
750 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
751 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
752 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
753 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
754 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
755 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
756 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
757 limit too high.
758
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100759tune.maxaccept <number>
760 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
761 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
762 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100763 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100764 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
765 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100766 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100767 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
768
769tune.maxpollevents <number>
770 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
771 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
772 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
773 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
774 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
775
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200776tune.maxrewrite <number>
777 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
778 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
779 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
780 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
781 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
782 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
783 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
784 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
785 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
786 bufsize.
787
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200788tune.pipesize <number>
789 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
790 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
791 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
792 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
793 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
794 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
795
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100796tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
797tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
798 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
799 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
800 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
801 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
802 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
803 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
804 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
805
806tune.sndbuf.client <number>
807tune.sndbuf.server <number>
808 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
809 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
810 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
811 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
812 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
813 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
814 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
815 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
816 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
817 notifying haproxy again.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008203.3. Debugging
821--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
823debug
824 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
825 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
826 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
827 system startup.
828
829quiet
830 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
831 line argument "-q".
832
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008343.4. Userlists
835--------------
836It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
837http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
838it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
839
840userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100841 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100842 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
843
844group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100845 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
847 proceeded by "users" keyword.
848
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100849user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
850 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100851 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
852 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100853 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
854 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100855 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
856 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
857
858
859 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100860 userlist L1
861 group G1 users tiger,scott
862 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100863
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100864 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
865 user scott insecure-password elgato
866 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100868 userlist L2
869 group G1
870 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100872 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
873 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
874 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100875
876 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200878
8793.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200880----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200881It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
882haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
883pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
884identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
885or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
886Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
887known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
888the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
889process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
890during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
891tables.
892
893peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400894 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200895 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
896
897peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
898 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
899 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
900 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
901 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
902 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
903 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
904
905 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
906 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
907
908 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
909 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
910 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
911 across all peers.
912
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200913 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200914 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100915 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
916 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
917 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200918
919 backend mybackend
920 mode tcp
921 balance roundrobin
922 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
923 stick on src
924
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100925 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
926 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200927
928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
933 - defaults <name>
934 - frontend <name>
935 - backend <name>
936 - listen <name>
937
938A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
939its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
940section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100941section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
943A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
944connections.
945
946A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
947to forward incoming connections.
948
949A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
950parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
953'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
954case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
955
956Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
957logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
958proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
959However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
960name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
961
962Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
963and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100964bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
966modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
967arbitrary criteria.
968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009704.1. Proxy keywords matrix
971--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200973The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
974limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
975they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
976limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100977marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200978option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200979and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
980with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
981specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
985------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
986acl - X X X
987appsession - - X X
988backlog X X X -
989balance X - X X
990bind - X X -
991bind-process X X X X
992block - X X X
993capture cookie - X X -
994capture request header - X X -
995capture response header - X X -
996clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +0200997compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100998contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
999cookie X - X X
1000default-server X - X X
1001default_backend X X X -
1002description - X X X
1003disabled X X X X
1004dispatch - - X X
1005enabled X X X X
1006errorfile X X X X
1007errorloc X X X X
1008errorloc302 X X X X
1009-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1010errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001011force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001012fullconn X - X X
1013grace X X X X
1014hash-type X - X X
1015http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001016http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001017http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001018http-request - X X X
1019id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001020ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001021log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022maxconn X X X -
1023mode X X X X
1024monitor fail - X X -
1025monitor-net X X X -
1026monitor-uri X X X -
1027option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1028option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1029option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1030option allbackups (*) X - X X
1031option checkcache (*) X - X X
1032option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1033option contstats (*) X X X -
1034option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1035option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1036option forceclose (*) X X X X
1037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1038option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001039option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001040option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1042option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1043option httpchk X - X X
1044option httpclose (*) X X X X
1045option httplog X X X X
1046option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001047option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001048option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001049option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1050option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1051option logasap (*) X X X -
1052option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001053option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001054option nolinger (*) X X X X
1055option originalto X X X X
1056option persist (*) X - X X
1057option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001058option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001059option smtpchk X - X X
1060option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1061option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1062option splice-request (*) X X X X
1063option splice-response (*) X X X X
1064option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1065option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1066-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1067option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1068option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1069option tcpka X X X X
1070option tcplog X X X X
1071option transparent (*) X - X X
1072persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1073rate-limit sessions X X X -
1074redirect - X X X
1075redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1076redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1077reqadd - X X X
1078reqallow - X X X
1079reqdel - X X X
1080reqdeny - X X X
1081reqiallow - X X X
1082reqidel - X X X
1083reqideny - X X X
1084reqipass - X X X
1085reqirep - X X X
1086reqisetbe - X X X
1087reqitarpit - X X X
1088reqpass - X X X
1089reqrep - X X X
1090-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1091reqsetbe - X X X
1092reqtarpit - X X X
1093retries X - X X
1094rspadd - X X X
1095rspdel - X X X
1096rspdeny - X X X
1097rspidel - X X X
1098rspideny - X X X
1099rspirep - X X X
1100rsprep - X X X
1101server - - X X
1102source X - X X
1103srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001104stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001105stats auth X - X X
1106stats enable X - X X
1107stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001108stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109stats realm X - X X
1110stats refresh X - X X
1111stats scope X - X X
1112stats show-desc X - X X
1113stats show-legends X - X X
1114stats show-node X - X X
1115stats uri X - X X
1116-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1117stick match - - X X
1118stick on - - X X
1119stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001120stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001122tcp-request connection - X X -
1123tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001124tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001125tcp-response content - - X X
1126tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001127timeout check X - X X
1128timeout client X X X -
1129timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1130timeout connect X - X X
1131timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1132timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1133timeout http-request X X X X
1134timeout queue X - X X
1135timeout server X - X X
1136timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1137timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001138timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001140unique-id-format X X X -
1141unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001142use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001143use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1145 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011484.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1149---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150
1151This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1152
1153
1154acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1155 Declare or complete an access list.
1156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1157 no | yes | yes | yes
1158 Example:
1159 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1160 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1161 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001163 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001164
1165
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001166appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1167 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1170 no | no | yes | yes
1171 Arguments :
1172 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1173 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1174
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001175 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001176 checked in each cookie value.
1177
1178 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1179 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1180 milliseconds.
1181
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001182 request-learn
1183 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1184 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1185 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1186 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1187 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1188 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1189
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001190 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1191 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1192 data following this prefix.
1193
1194 Example :
1195 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1196
1197 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1198 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1199
1200 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1201 2 modes are currently supported :
1202 - path-parameters :
1203 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1204 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1205 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1206 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1207 - query-string :
1208 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1209 query string.
1210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001211 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1212 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1213 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1214 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001215 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1216 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1217 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1219 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1220
1221 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1222
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001223 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1224 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1225 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001227 Example :
1228 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1229
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001230 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1231 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
1233
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001234backlog <conns>
1235 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1237 yes | yes | yes | no
1238 Arguments :
1239 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1240 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001241 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001242
1243 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1244 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1245 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1246 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1247 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1248 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1249 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1250 backlog parameter.
1251
1252 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1253 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1254 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1255
1256 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1257
1258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001260balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1263 yes | no | yes | yes
1264 Arguments :
1265 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1266 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1267 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1268 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1269
1270 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1271 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1272 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1273 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001274 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1275 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1276 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1277 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1278 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1279 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1280 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1281 it, so that you don't worry.
1282
1283 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1284 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1285 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1286 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1287 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1288 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1289 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1290 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001292 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1293 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1294 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1295 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1296 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1297 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1298 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1299 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1300
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001301 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1302 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1303 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1304 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001305 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001306 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1307 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1308 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1309 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1310 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001311 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1312 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1313 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1314 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1315 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1316 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001318 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1319 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1320 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1321 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1322 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1323 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1324 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1325 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001326 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001327 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001328 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1329 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1330 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001331
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001332 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1333 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1334 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1335 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1336 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1337 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1338 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1339 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1340 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1341 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1342 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1343 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001345 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001346 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1347 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1348 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1349 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1350 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1351 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1352 URIs start with a leading "/".
1353
1354 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1355 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1356 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1357 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001359 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001360 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1361
1362 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001363 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1364 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1365 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1366 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1367 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1368 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1369 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1370 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1371 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1372 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1373 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1374 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1375 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1376 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1377 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1378 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1379 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1380 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1381 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001382
1383 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1384 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1385 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1386 server will receive the request.
1387
1388 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1389 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1390 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1391 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1392 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001393 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1394 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1395 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001396
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001397 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1398 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1399 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1400 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1401 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001403 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001404 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1405 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1406 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1407
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001408 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1409 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1410 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1411
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001412 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001413 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001414 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1415 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1416 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1417 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1418 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1419 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001420 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001421 used instead.
1422
1423 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1424 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1425 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1426 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1427
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001428 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1429 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1430 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001432 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001435 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1436 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001437
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001438 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001440
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001441 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1442 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1443 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444
1445 Examples :
1446 balance roundrobin
1447 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001448 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001449 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1450 balance hdr(host)
1451 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001452
1453 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1454 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001456 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001457 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1458 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1459 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1460 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1461
1462 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1463 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1464 defaults to 16 kB.
1465
1466 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1467 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1468
1469 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1470 Round Robin.
1471
1472 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1473 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1474 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1475 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1476
1477 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1478
1479 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001480 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001481 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1482 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1483 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001485 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1486 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1490bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | yes | yes | no
1494 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001495 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1496 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1497 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1498 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001499 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001500
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001501 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1502 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001503 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1504 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1505 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001506 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1507 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1508 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1509 the range.
1510
1511 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1512 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1513 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1514 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1515 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1516 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1517 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001518 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001519 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001521 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1522 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1523 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1524 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1525 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1526 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1527 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1528 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001530 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1531 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1532 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1533 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1536 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1537 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1538 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1539 in a frontend.
1540
1541 Example :
1542 listen http_proxy
1543 bind :80,:443
1544 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001545 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001547 listen http_https_proxy
1548 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001549 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001550
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001551 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001552 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001553
1554
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001555bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1556 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1558 yes | yes | yes | yes
1559 Arguments :
1560 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1561 may be used to override a default value.
1562
1563 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1564 option may be combined with other numbers.
1565
1566 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1567 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1568 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1569 missing from all processes.
1570
1571 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1572 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1573 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1574 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1575
1576 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1577 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1578 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1579 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1580 and 'even' instances.
1581
1582 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1583 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1584 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1585 32.
1586
1587 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1588 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1589
1590 Example :
1591 listen app_ip1
1592 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001593 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001594
1595 listen app_ip2
1596 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001597 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001598
1599 listen management
1600 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001601 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001602
1603 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1604
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606block { if | unless } <condition>
1607 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1609 no | yes | yes | yes
1610
1611 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1612 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001613 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001614 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1616 "block" statements per instance.
1617
1618 Example:
1619 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1620 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1621 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1622 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001624 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625
1626
1627capture cookie <name> len <length>
1628 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1630 no | yes | yes | no
1631 Arguments :
1632 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1633 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1634 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1635 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1636 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1637
1638 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1639 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1640 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1641 right if it exceeds <length>.
1642
1643 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1644 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1645 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1646 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1647
1648 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1649 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1650 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1651
1652 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1653 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1654 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1655 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001656 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1658
1659 Example:
1660 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1661
1662 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001663 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001664
1665
1666capture request header <name> len <length>
1667 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1669 no | yes | yes | no
1670 Arguments :
1671 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001672 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001673 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1674 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1675 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1676
1677 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1678 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1679 it exceeds <length>.
1680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001681 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1683 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001684 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1685 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1686 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1687 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001688 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001689 environments to find where the request came from.
1690
1691 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1692 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1693 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1694 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
1696 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1697 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1698 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1699 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1700
1701 Example:
1702 capture request header Host len 15
1703 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1704 capture request header Referrer len 15
1705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001706 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707 about logging.
1708
1709
1710capture response header <name> len <length>
1711 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1713 no | yes | yes | no
1714 Arguments :
1715 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001716 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1718 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1719 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1720
1721 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1722 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1723 it exceeds <length>.
1724
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001725 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1727 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1728 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001729 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1730 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1731 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1732 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
1734 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1735 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1736 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1737 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1738
1739 Example:
1740 capture response header Content-length len 9
1741 capture response header Location len 15
1742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001743 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 about logging.
1745
1746
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001747clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1750 yes | yes | yes | no
1751 Arguments :
1752 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1753 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1754 as explained at the top of this document.
1755
1756 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1757 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1758 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1759 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1760 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1761 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1762 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1763 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001764 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001765 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1766 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1767
1768 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1769 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1770 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1771 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1772 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1773 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1774
1775 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1776 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1777
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001778 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1779 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001781compression algo [ gzip ] ...
1782compression type ...
1783 Enable HTTP compression.
1784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1785 yes | yes | yes | yes
1786 Arguments :
1787 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1788 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1789
1790 Examples :
1791 compression algo gzip
1792 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001794contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1797 yes | no | yes | yes
1798 Arguments :
1799 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1801 as explained at the top of this document.
1802
1803 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001804 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001805 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1807 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1808 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1809 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1810
1811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1813 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1814 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1815 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1816 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1817
1818 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1819 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1820 instead.
1821
1822 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1823 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1824
1825
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001826cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001827 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1828 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1831 yes | no | yes | yes
1832 Arguments :
1833 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1834 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1835 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1836 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1837 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1838 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1839 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1840 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1841 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1842
1843 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1844 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1845 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1846 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1847 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1848 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1849 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1850 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1851 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1852 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1853 "insert" and "prefix".
1854
1855 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001856 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001857
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001858 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001859 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1860 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1861 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1862 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1863 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1864 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1865 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1866 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1867 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1868 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
1870 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1871 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1872 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1873 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1874 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1875 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1876 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1877 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1878 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1879 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001880 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1881 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1882 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001884 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1885 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1886 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001887 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1888 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1889 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1890 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001891 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1892 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1893 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
1895 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1896 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1897 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1898 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1899 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1900 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1901 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1902 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1903 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1904
1905 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1906 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1907 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1908 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1909 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1910 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1911 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1912 persistence cookie in the cache.
1913 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1914
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001915 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1916 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1917 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1918 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1919 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1920 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1921 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1922 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1923 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1924 they logout.
1925
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001926 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1927 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1928 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1929 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1930
1931 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1932 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1933 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1934 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1935 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1936 this attribute.
1937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001938 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001939 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001940 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1941 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1942 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1943 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1944 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1945 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001946
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001947 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1948 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1949 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1950 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1951 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1952 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1953 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1954 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1955 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1956 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1957 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1958 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1959 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1960 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1961 the site.
1962
1963 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1964 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1965 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1966 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1967 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1968 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1969 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1970 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1971 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1972 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1973 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1974 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1975 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1976 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1977 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1978 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1981 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1982 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1983 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001984
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001985 Examples :
1986 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1987 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1988 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001989 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001991 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001992 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001995default-server [param*]
1996 Change default options for a server in a backend
1997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1998 yes | no | yes | yes
1999 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002000 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2001 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2002 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2003 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002004
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002005 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002006 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2007
2008 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011default_backend <backend>
2012 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2014 yes | yes | yes | no
2015 Arguments :
2016 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2017
2018 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2019 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2020 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2021 will catch all undetermined requests.
2022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023 Example :
2024
2025 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2026 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2027 default_backend dynamic
2028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002029 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031
2032disabled
2033 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 yes | yes | yes | yes
2036 Arguments : none
2037
2038 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2039 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2040 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2041 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2042 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2043 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2044 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2045
2046 See also : "enabled"
2047
2048
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002049dispatch <address>:<port>
2050 Set a default server address
2051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2052 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002053 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002054
2055 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2056 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2057 during start-up.
2058
2059 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2060 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2061 possible with normal servers.
2062
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002063 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002064 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2065 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2066 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2067 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2068
2069 See also : "server"
2070
2071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072enabled
2073 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2075 yes | yes | yes | yes
2076 Arguments : none
2077
2078 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2079 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2080
2081 See also : "disabled"
2082
2083
2084errorfile <code> <file>
2085 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2087 yes | yes | yes | yes
2088 Arguments :
2089 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002090 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091
2092 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002093 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002095 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2096 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
2098 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2099 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2100 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2101
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002102 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2105 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2106 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2107 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2108
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002109 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2110 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2111 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2112 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2113 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2114 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2117 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2118 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002119 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2121
2122 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2123
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002124 Example :
2125 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2126 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2127 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2128
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002129
2130errorloc <code> <url>
2131errorloc302 <code> <url>
2132 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2134 yes | yes | yes | yes
2135 Arguments :
2136 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002137 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002138
2139 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2140 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2141 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2142 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2143 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2144
2145 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2146 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2147 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2148
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002149 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2150
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002151 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2152 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2153 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2154 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2155 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2156 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2157 request.
2158
2159 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2160
2161
2162errorloc303 <code> <url>
2163 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | yes | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2168 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2169
2170 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2171 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2172 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2173 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2174 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2175
2176 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2177 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2178 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2179
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002180 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2181
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002182 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2183 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2184 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2185 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002186 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002187
2188 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2189
2190
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002191force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2192 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 no | yes | yes | yes
2195
2196 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2197 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2198 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2199 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2200 marked down for maintenance operations.
2201
2202 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2203 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2204 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2205 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2206 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2207 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2208 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2209 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2210 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2211
2212 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2213 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2214 is used.
2215
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002216 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002217 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002218
2219
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220fullconn <conns>
2221 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 yes | no | yes | yes
2224 Arguments :
2225 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2226 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2227
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002228 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002229 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002230 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002231 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2232 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2233 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2234 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2235 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002236 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002237
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002238 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2239 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2240 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002242 Example :
2243 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2244 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2245 # connections.
2246 backend dynamic
2247 fullconn 10000
2248 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2249 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2250
2251 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2252
2253
2254grace <time>
2255 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002257 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002258 Arguments :
2259 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2260 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2261 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2262
2263 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2264 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002265 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002266 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2267
2268 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2269 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2270 simplify it.
2271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002272
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002273hash-type <method>
2274 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2276 yes | no | yes | yes
2277 Arguments :
2278 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2279 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2280 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2281 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2282 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2283 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2284 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2285 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2286 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2287
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002288 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2289 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2290 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2291 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2292 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2293 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2294 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2295 this value.
2296
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002297 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2298 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2299 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2300 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2301 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2302 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2303 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2304 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2305 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2306 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2307 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2308 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2309 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2310
2311 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2312
2313 See also : "balance", "server"
2314
2315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316http-check disable-on-404
2317 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002319 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 Arguments : none
2321
2322 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2323 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2324 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2325 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2326 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2327 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2328 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2329 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002330 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2331 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2332 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2333
2334 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2335
2336
2337http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002338 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002340 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002341 Arguments :
2342 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2343 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002344 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002345 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2346 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2347 details on the supported keywords.
2348
2349 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2350 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2351 with the usual backslash ('\').
2352
2353 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2354 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2355 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2356 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2357 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2358
2359 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002360 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002361 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2362 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2363 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2364
2365 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002366 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002367 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2368 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2369 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2370 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2371
2372 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002373 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002374 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2375 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2376 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2377 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2378 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2379 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2380 trace).
2381
2382 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002383 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002384 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2385 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2386 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2387 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2388 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2389 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2390
2391 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2392 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2393 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2394 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2395 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2396 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2397 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2398 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2399
2400 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2401 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2402
2403 Examples :
2404 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002405 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002406
2407 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002408 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002409
2410 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002411 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002412
2413 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002414 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002416 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002417
2418
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002419http-check send-state
2420 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2422 yes | no | yes | yes
2423 Arguments : none
2424
2425 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2426 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2427 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2428 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2429 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2430
2431 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2432 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2433 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2434 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2435 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2436 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2437 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2438 checked in multiple backends.
2439
2440 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2441 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2442
2443 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2444 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2445 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2446 one fails.
2447
2448 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2449 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2450 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2451
2452 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2453 server's queue.
2454
2455 Example of a header received by the application server :
2456 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2457 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2458
2459 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2460
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002461http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002462 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002463 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2464
2465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2466 no | yes | yes | yes
2467
2468 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2469 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2470 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002471 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2472 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002473 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2474
2475 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2476 instance.
2477
2478 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002479 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2480 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2481 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002482
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002483 http-request allow if nagios
2484 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2485 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2486 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002487
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002488 Example:
2489 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002490
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002491 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002492
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002493 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2494 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002495
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002496http-send-name-header [<header>]
2497 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2498
2499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2500 yes | no | yes | yes
2501
2502 Arguments :
2503
2504 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2505
2506 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2507 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2508 is added with the header string proved.
2509
2510 See also : "server"
2511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002512id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002513 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2515 no | yes | yes | yes
2516 Arguments : none
2517
2518 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2519 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2520 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002521
2522
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002523ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2524 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 no | yes | yes | yes
2527
2528 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2529 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2530 and running).
2531
2532 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2533 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2534 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2535 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2536 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2537
2538 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2539 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2540
2541 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2542 "unless" condition is met.
2543
2544 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2545
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002548log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002549no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002550 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002553
2554 Prefix :
2555 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2556 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2557 prefix does not allow arguments.
2558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002559 Arguments :
2560 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2561 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2562 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2563 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2564 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2565 parameter.
2566
2567 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2568 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2569
2570 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2571 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2572 standard syslog port).
2573
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002574 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2575 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2576 standard syslog port).
2577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2579 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2580 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2581 appropriately writeable).
2582
2583 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2584
2585 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2586 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2587 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2588
2589 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2590 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2591 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002592 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2593 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2594 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2595 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2596 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002597
2598 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2599
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002600 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2601 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2602 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002603
2604 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2605 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2606 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2607 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2608
2609 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2610 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002611
2612 Example :
2613 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002614 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2615 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002617log-format <string>
2618 Allows you to custom a log line.
2619
2620 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2621
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002622
2623maxconn <conns>
2624 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 yes | yes | yes | no
2627 Arguments :
2628 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2629 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2630 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2631 closes.
2632
2633 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2634 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2635 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2636 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2637 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2638 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2639 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2640 properly tuned.
2641
2642 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2643 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2644 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2645
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002646 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2649
2650
2651mode { tcp|http|health }
2652 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | yes | yes | yes
2655 Arguments :
2656 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2657 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2658 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2659 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2660
2661 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2662 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2663 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2664 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2665 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2666
2667 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002668 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2669 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2670 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2671 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2672 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2673 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2674 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002675
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002676 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2677 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2678 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002679
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002680 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681 defaults http_instances
2682 mode http
2683
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002684 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002687monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002688 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2690 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691 Arguments :
2692 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2693 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002694 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2696 backend and its backup.
2697
2698 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2699 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2700 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2701 servers in a list of backends.
2702
2703 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2704 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2705 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2706 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2707 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2708 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2709 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002710 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2711 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
2713 Example:
2714 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2717 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2718 monitor-uri /site_alive
2719 monitor fail if site_dead
2720
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002721 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002722
2723
2724monitor-net <source>
2725 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2727 yes | yes | yes | no
2728 Arguments :
2729 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2730 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2731 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2732 followed by a mask.
2733
2734 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2735 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002736 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002737 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2738
2739 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2740 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2741 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2742 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002743 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2744 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2745 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002746
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002747 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2748 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2749 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2750 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2751 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2752 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002753
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002754 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2755 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002756
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002757 Example :
2758 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2759 frontend www
2760 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2761
2762 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2763
2764
2765monitor-uri <uri>
2766 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2768 yes | yes | yes | no
2769 Arguments :
2770 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2771 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2772
2773 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2774 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2775 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2776 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2777 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2778 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2779 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2780 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2781
2782 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2783 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2784 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2785 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2786 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2787 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2788
2789 Example :
2790 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2791 frontend www
2792 mode http
2793 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2794
2795 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002798option abortonclose
2799no option abortonclose
2800 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | no | yes | yes
2803 Arguments : none
2804
2805 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2806 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2807 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2808 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002809 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002810 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2811 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2812 encountered while delivering the response.
2813
2814 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2815 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2816 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2817 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2818 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2819 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002820 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002821 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002822 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002823 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2824 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2825 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2826
2827 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2828 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2829 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2830 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2831 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2832 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2833 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2834 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002835 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002836
2837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2839
2840 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2841
2842
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002843option accept-invalid-http-request
2844no option accept-invalid-http-request
2845 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2847 yes | yes | yes | no
2848 Arguments : none
2849
2850 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2851 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2852 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2853 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2854 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2855 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2856 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2857 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002858 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2859 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2860 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2861 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2862 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2863 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002864
2865 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2866 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2867 been confirmed.
2868
2869 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2870 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002871 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2872 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002873 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2874
2875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2877
2878 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2879 stats socket.
2880
2881
2882option accept-invalid-http-response
2883no option accept-invalid-http-response
2884 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2886 yes | no | yes | yes
2887 Arguments : none
2888
2889 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2890 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2891 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2892 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2893 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2894 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2895 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2896 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2897 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2898
2899 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2900 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2901 been confirmed.
2902
2903 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2904 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2905 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2906 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2907
2908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2910
2911 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2912 stats socket.
2913
2914
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002915option allbackups
2916no option allbackups
2917 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2919 yes | no | yes | yes
2920 Arguments : none
2921
2922 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2923 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2924 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2925 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2926 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2927 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2928 order between the backup servers anymore.
2929
2930 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2931 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2932
2933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2935
2936
2937option checkcache
2938no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002939 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2941 yes | no | yes | yes
2942 Arguments : none
2943
2944 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2945 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002946 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002947 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2948 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002949 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002950
2951 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002952 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002953 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002954 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2955 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002956 to the client are :
2957 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002958 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002959 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002960 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2961 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2962 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2963 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2964 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2965 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2966 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2967 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2968 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2969 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2970 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2971
2972 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002973 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002974 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002975 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002976 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2977
2978 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2979 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002980 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002981 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2982
2983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2985
2986
2987option clitcpka
2988no option clitcpka
2989 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | no
2992 Arguments : none
2993
2994 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2995 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2996 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2997 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2998
2999 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3000 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3001 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3002 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3003
3004 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3005 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3006 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3007 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3008 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3009
3010 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3011
3012 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3013 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3014 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3015
3016 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3017 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3018
3019 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3020
3021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022option contstats
3023 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3025 yes | yes | yes | no
3026 Arguments : none
3027
3028 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3029 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3030 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3031 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3032 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3033 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3034 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3035
3036
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003037option dontlog-normal
3038no option dontlog-normal
3039 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3041 yes | yes | yes | no
3042 Arguments : none
3043
3044 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3045 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3046 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3047 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3048 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3049 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3050 logged.
3051
3052 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3053 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3054 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003056 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003057 logging.
3058
3059
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003060option dontlognull
3061no option dontlognull
3062 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3064 yes | yes | yes | no
3065 Arguments : none
3066
3067 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3068 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3069 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3070 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3071 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3072 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3073 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3074
3075 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3076 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3077 would not be logged.
3078
3079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003082 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003083
3084
3085option forceclose
3086no option forceclose
3087 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003089 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003090 Arguments : none
3091
3092 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3093 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3094 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3095 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3096 global session times in the logs.
3097
3098 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003099 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003100 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3101 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3102 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3103 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003104
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003105 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3106 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3107 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3108
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3111
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003112 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003113
3114
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003115option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003116 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 yes | yes | yes | yes
3119 Arguments :
3120 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3121 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003122 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003123 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003124
3125 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3126 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3127 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3128 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3129 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3130 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3131 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003132 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3133 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3134 possible that the client has already brought one.
3135
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003136 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003137 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003138 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3139 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003140 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3141 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003142
3143 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3144 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3145 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3146 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3147 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3148 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3149 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3150
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003151 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3152 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3153 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3154 are under the control of the end-user.
3155
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003156 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003157 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3158 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003159 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3160 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3161 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003162
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003163 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3164 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3165 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3166 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3167 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003168
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003169 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003170 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3171 frontend www
3172 mode http
3173 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3174
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003175 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3176 backend www
3177 mode http
3178 option forwardfor header X-Client
3179
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003180 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3181 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003182
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003183
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003184option http-no-delay
3185no option http-no-delay
3186 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189 Arguments : none
3190
3191 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3192 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3193 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3194 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3195 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3196 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3197 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3198 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3199 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3200 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3201 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3202 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3203 affected.
3204
3205 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3206 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3207 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3208 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3209 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3210 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3211 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3212 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3213 latency environments.
3214
3215
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003216option http-pretend-keepalive
3217no option http-pretend-keepalive
3218 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3220 yes | yes | yes | yes
3221 Arguments : none
3222
3223 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3224 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3225 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3226 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3227 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3228 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3229 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3230 consider the response complete.
3231
3232 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3233 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3234 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3235 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3236 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3237 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3238
3239 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3240 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3241 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3242 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3243 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3244 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3245 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3246
3247 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3248 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003249 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003250 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3251 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003252
3253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3255
3256 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3257
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003258
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003259option http-server-close
3260no option http-server-close
3261 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3263 yes | yes | yes | yes
3264 Arguments : none
3265
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003266 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3267 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3268 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3269 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3270 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3271 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3272 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3273 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3274 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3275 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3276 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3277 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003278
3279 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3280 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3281 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3282 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003283 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3284 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003285
3286 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3287 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003288 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3289 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3290 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003291
3292 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3293 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3294
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003295 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3296 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003297
3298
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003299option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003300no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003301 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3303 yes | yes | yes | no
3304 Arguments : none
3305
3306 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3307 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3308 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3309 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3310 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3311 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3312 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3313
3314 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3315 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3316 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3317 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3318 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3319 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3320 request along its whole life.
3321
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003322 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3323 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3324 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3325 front of an existing proxy.
3326
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003327 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3328
3329 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3330 http-server-close".
3331
3332
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003333option httpchk
3334option httpchk <uri>
3335option httpchk <method> <uri>
3336option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3337 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3339 yes | no | yes | yes
3340 Arguments :
3341 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3342 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3343 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3344 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3345 ones.
3346
3347 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3348 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3349 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3350
3351 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3352 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3353 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3354 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3355 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3356
3357 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3358 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3359 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3360 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3361 the lack of any response.
3362
3363 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3364
3365 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3366 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3367 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3368
3369 Examples :
3370 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3371 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3372 backend https_relay
3373 mode tcp
3374 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3375 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3376
3377 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003378 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3379 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003380
3381
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003382option httpclose
3383no option httpclose
3384 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments : none
3388
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003389 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3390 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3391 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3392 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3393 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3394 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3395 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003396
3397 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003398 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003399 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3400 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3401 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3402 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3403 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003404
3405 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3406 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3407 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003408 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3409 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003410
3411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3413
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003414 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3415 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003416
3417
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003418option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003419 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3421 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003422 Arguments :
3423 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3424 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3425 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3426 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3427 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
3429 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3430 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3431 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3432 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3433 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3434 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3435 ports.
3436
3437 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3438
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003439 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3440 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3441 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3442 by default.
3443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003444 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003445
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003446
3447option http_proxy
3448no option http_proxy
3449 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | yes | yes | yes
3452 Arguments : none
3453
3454 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3455 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3456 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3457 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3458 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3459
3460 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3461 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3462 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3463 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003464 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003465 be analyzed.
3466
3467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3469
3470 Example :
3471 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3472 backend direct_forward
3473 option httpclose
3474 option http_proxy
3475
3476 See also : "option httpclose"
3477
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003478
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003479option independent-streams
3480no option independent-streams
3481 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | yes
3484 Arguments : none
3485
3486 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3487 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3488 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3489 receive data or not.
3490
3491 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3492 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3493 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3494 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3495 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3496 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3497 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3498 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3499 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3500 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3501 socket buffers.
3502
3503 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3504 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3505 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3506 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3507 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3508
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003509 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3510 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3511 deprecated.
3512
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003513 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003514
3515
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003516option ldap-check
3517 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | no | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : none
3521
3522 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3523 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3524 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3525 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3526
3527 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3528 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3529
3530 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3531 configure it.
3532
3533 Example :
3534 option ldap-check
3535
3536 See also : "option httpchk"
3537
3538
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003539option log-health-checks
3540no option log-health-checks
3541 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | no | yes | yes
3544 Arguments : none
3545
3546 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3547 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3548 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3549 of additional information is limited.
3550
3551 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3552 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3553
3554 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3555
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003556
3557option log-separate-errors
3558no option log-separate-errors
3559 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | yes | yes | no
3562 Arguments : none
3563
3564 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3565 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3566 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3567 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3568 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3569 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3570 provides very important information.
3571
3572 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3573 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3574 error logs.
3575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003576 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003577 logging.
3578
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003579
3580option logasap
3581no option logasap
3582 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | yes | yes | no
3585 Arguments : none
3586
3587 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3588 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3589 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3590 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3591 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3592 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3593 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003594 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003595 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3596 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3597
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003598 Examples :
3599 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3600 mode http
3601 option httplog
3602 option logasap
3603 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3604
3605 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3606 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3607 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3608 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003610 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611 logging.
3612
3613
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003614option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3615 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003618 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3620 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003621
3622 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3623 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3624 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3625 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3626 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3627 in the MySQL table, like this :
3628
3629 USE mysql;
3630 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3631 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3632
3633 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3634 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3635 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3636 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3637 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3638 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3639 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3640 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3641 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3642
3643 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3644 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003645
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003646 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003647
3648 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3649 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3650 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3651 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3652 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3653 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3654
3655 See also: "option httpchk"
3656
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003657option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3658 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | no | yes | yes
3661 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003662 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3663 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003664
3665 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3666 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3667 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3668 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3669
3670 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003671
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003672option nolinger
3673no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003674 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003677 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003678
3679 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3680 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3681 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3682 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3683 connections.
3684
3685 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3686 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3687 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3688 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3689 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3690 this too.
3691
3692 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3693 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3694 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3695
3696 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3697 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3698 for servers.
3699
3700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3702
3703
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003704option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3705 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3707 yes | yes | yes | yes
3708 Arguments :
3709 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3710 matching <network>
3711 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3712 header name.
3713
3714 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3715 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3716 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3717 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3718 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3719 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3720 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3721 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3722 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3723 possible that the client has already brought one.
3724
3725 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3726 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3727 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3728 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3729 header and requires different one.
3730
3731 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3732 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3733 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3734 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3735 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3736 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3737 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3738
3739 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3740 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3741 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3742 both are defined.
3743
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003744 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3745 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3746 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3747 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3748 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003749
3750 Examples :
3751 # Original Destination address
3752 frontend www
3753 mode http
3754 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3755
3756 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3757 backend www
3758 mode http
3759 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3760
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003761 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3762 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003763
3764
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003765option persist
3766no option persist
3767 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003770 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003771
3772 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3773 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3774 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3775 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3776 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3777 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3778 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3779 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3780 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3781 redirected to another valid server.
3782
3783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3785
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003786 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003787
3788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003789option redispatch
3790no option redispatch
3791 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003794 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003795
3796 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3797 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3798 be able to access the service anymore.
3799
3800 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3801 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3802
3803 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3804 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3805 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003807 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3808 "redisp" keywords.
3809
3810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3812
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003813 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003814
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003815
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003816option redis-check
3817 Use redis health checks for server testing
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments : none
3821
3822 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3823 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3824 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3825 find the "+PONG" response message.
3826
3827 Example :
3828 option redis-check
3829
3830 See also : "option httpchk"
3831
3832
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003833option smtpchk
3834option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3835 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003839 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3840 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3841 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3842
3843 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3844 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3845 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3846
3847 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3848 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3849 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3850 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3851 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3852 dead server.
3853
3854 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3855 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3856 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3857 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3858
3859 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3860 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3861 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3862 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3863 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3864
3865 Example :
3866 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3867
3868 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003871option socket-stats
3872no option socket-stats
3873
3874 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | no
3877
3878 Arguments : none
3879
3880
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003881option splice-auto
3882no option splice-auto
3883 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | yes
3886 Arguments : none
3887
3888 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3889 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3890 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3891 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003892 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003893 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3894 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3895 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3896 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3897
3898 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3899 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3900 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3901 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3902 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3903 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3904 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3905 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3906 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3907 keyword.
3908
3909 Example :
3910 option splice-auto
3911
3912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3914
3915 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3916 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3917
3918
3919option splice-request
3920no option splice-request
3921 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3923 yes | yes | yes | yes
3924 Arguments : none
3925
3926 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003927 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003928 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3929 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3930 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3931 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3932
3933 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3934
3935 Example :
3936 option splice-request
3937
3938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3940
3941 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3942 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3943
3944
3945option splice-response
3946no option splice-response
3947 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | yes | yes | yes
3950 Arguments : none
3951
3952 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003953 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003954 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3955 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3956 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3957 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3958
3959 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3960
3961 Example :
3962 option splice-response
3963
3964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3966
3967 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3968 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3969
3970
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003971option srvtcpka
3972no option srvtcpka
3973 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | no | yes | yes
3976 Arguments : none
3977
3978 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3979 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3980 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3981 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3982
3983 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3984 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3985 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3986 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3987
3988 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3989 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3990 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3991 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3992 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3993
3994 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3995
3996 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3997 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3998 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3999
4000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4002
4003 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4004
4005
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004006option ssl-hello-chk
4007 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | no | yes | yes
4010 Arguments : none
4011
4012 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4013 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4014 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4015 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4016 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4017 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4018 hello message.
4019
4020 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4021 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4022 messages, which is appreciable.
4023
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004024 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4025 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4026 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004027
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004028 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4029
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004030
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004031option tcp-smart-accept
4032no option tcp-smart-accept
4033 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4035 yes | yes | yes | no
4036 Arguments : none
4037
4038 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4039 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4040 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4041 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4042 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4043 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4044
4045 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4046 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4047 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4048 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4049
4050 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4051 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4052 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4053 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4054
4055 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4056 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4057 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4058
4059 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4060 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4061 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4062
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004063 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4064
4065
4066option tcp-smart-connect
4067no option tcp-smart-connect
4068 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 yes | no | yes | yes
4071 Arguments : none
4072
4073 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4074 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4075 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4076 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4077 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4078
4079 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4080 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4081 complex.
4082
4083 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4084 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4085 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4086
4087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4089
4090 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4091
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004092
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004093option tcpka
4094 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | yes | yes | yes
4097 Arguments : none
4098
4099 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4100 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4101 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4102 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4103
4104 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4105 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4106 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4107 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4108
4109 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4110 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4111 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4112 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4113 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4114
4115 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4116
4117 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4118 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4119 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4120 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4121 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4122 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4123 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4124 backends.
4125
4126 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4127
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004128
4129option tcplog
4130 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | yes
4133 Arguments : none
4134
4135 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4136 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4137 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4138 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4139 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4140 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4141 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4142 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4143
4144 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004146 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004147
4148
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004149option transparent
4150no option transparent
4151 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004153 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004154 Arguments : none
4155
4156 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4157 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4158 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4159 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4160 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4161 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4162 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4163 appropriate server.
4164
4165 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4166 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4167
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004168 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004169 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004171
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004172persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004173persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004174 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4176 yes | no | yes | yes
4177 Arguments :
4178 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004179 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4180 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004181
4182 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4183 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4184 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4185 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4186 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4187 forwarded to this server.
4188
4189 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4190 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4191 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004192 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004193 a single "listen" section.
4194
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004195 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4196 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4197 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4198
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004199 Example :
4200 listen tse-farm
4201 bind :3389
4202 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4203 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4204 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4205 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4206 persist rdp-cookie
4207 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004208 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004209 balance rdp-cookie
4210 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4211 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4212
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004213 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4214 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004215
4216
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004217rate-limit sessions <rate>
4218 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4220 yes | yes | yes | no
4221 Arguments :
4222 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4223 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4224
4225 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4226 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4227 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4228 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4229 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4230 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4231
4232 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4233 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4234 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4235 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4236
4237 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4238 listen smtp
4239 mode tcp
4240 bind :25
4241 rate-limit sessions 10
4242 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4243
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004244 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4245 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4246 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004247
4248 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4249
4250
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004251redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4252redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4253redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004254 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 no | yes | yes | yes
4257
4258 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004259 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004260
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004262 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4263 the HTTP "Location" header.
4264
4265 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4266 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4267 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4268 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4269 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4270 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4271
4272 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4273 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4274 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4275 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4276 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4277 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4278 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4279 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4280 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004281
4282 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4283 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4284 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4285 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4286 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4287 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4288 location with a GET method.
4289
4290 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4291 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4292
4293 - "drop-query"
4294 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4295 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4296 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4297 with a location-type redirect.
4298
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004299 - "append-slash"
4300 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4301 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4302 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4303 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4304
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004305 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4306 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4307 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4308 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4309 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4310 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4311 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4312
4313 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4314 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4315 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4316 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4317 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4318 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4319 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004320
4321 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4322 acl clear dst_port 80
4323 acl secure dst_port 8080
4324 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004325 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004326 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004327 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4328
4329 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004330 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4331 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4332 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004333 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004334
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004335 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4336 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4337 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4338
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004339 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4340 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004342 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004343
4344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004345redisp (deprecated)
4346redispatch (deprecated)
4347 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4349 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004350 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004351
4352 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4353 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4354 be able to access the service anymore.
4355
4356 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4357 redistribute them to a working server.
4358
4359 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4360 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4361 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004363 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4364 "option redispatch" instead.
4365
4366 See also : "option redispatch"
4367
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004368
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004369reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 no | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments :
4374 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4375 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004376 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004377
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004378 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4379 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4380
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004381 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4382 the last header of an HTTP request.
4383
4384 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4385 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4386 responses.
4387
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004388 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4389 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4390 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4391
4392 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4393 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004394
4395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004396reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4397reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004398 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 no | yes | yes | yes
4401 Arguments :
4402 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4403 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4404 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4405 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4406 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4407 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4408 ignores case.
4409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004413 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4414 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4415 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4416 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004417 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004418
4419 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4420 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4421
4422 Example :
4423 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4424 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4425 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4426
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004427 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4428 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004429
4430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004431reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4432reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004433 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4435 no | yes | yes | yes
4436 Arguments :
4437 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4438 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4439 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4440 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4441 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4442 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4443
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004444 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4445 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4446
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004447 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4448 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4449 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4450 next servers.
4451
4452 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4453 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4454 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4455
4456 Example :
4457 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4458 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4459 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004461 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4462 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004463
4464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004465reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4466reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004467 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4469 no | yes | yes | yes
4470 Arguments :
4471 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4472 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4473 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4474 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4475 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4476 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4477 case.
4478
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004479 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4480 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4481
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4483 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4484 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4485 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004486 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004487
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004488 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004489 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004490 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004492 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4493 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4494
4495 Example :
4496 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4497 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4498 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004500 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4501 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004502
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4505reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 no | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4511 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4512 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4513 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4514 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4515 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4516 case.
4517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004518 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4519 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4520
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004521 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4522 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4523 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4524 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4525
4526 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4527 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4528
4529 Example :
4530 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4531 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4532 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4533 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4534
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004535 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4536 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004537
4538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004539reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4540reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004541 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 no | yes | yes | yes
4544 Arguments :
4545 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4546 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4547 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4548 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4549 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4550 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4551
4552 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4553 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4554 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4555 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004556 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004557
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004558 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4559 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4560
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004561 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4562 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4563 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4564
4565 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4566 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4567 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4568 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4569 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4570
4571 Example :
4572 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004573 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4575 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4576
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004577 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4578 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004579
4580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004581reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4582reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 no | yes | yes | yes
4586 Arguments :
4587 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4588 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4589 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4590 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4591 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4592 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4593 ignores case.
4594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4599 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004600 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4601 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4602 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4604 not set.
4605
4606 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4607 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4608 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4609 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4610 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4611
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004612 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004613 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4614 # block all others.
4615 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4616 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004618 # block bad guys
4619 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4620 reqitarpit . if badguys
4621
4622 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4623 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004624
4625
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004626retries <value>
4627 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4629 yes | no | yes | yes
4630 Arguments :
4631 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4632 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4633 default value is 3.
4634
4635 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4636 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4637 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4638
4639 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4640 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4641
4642 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4643 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4644
4645 See also : "option redispatch"
4646
4647
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004648rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004649 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 no | yes | yes | yes
4652 Arguments :
4653 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4654 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004655 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004656
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004657 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4658 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4659
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004660 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4661 the last header of an HTTP response.
4662
4663 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4664 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4665 responses.
4666
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004667 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4668 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004669
4670
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004671rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4672rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004673 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 no | yes | yes | yes
4676 Arguments :
4677 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4678 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4679 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4680 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4681 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4682 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4683 ignores case.
4684
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004685 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4686 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4687
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004688 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4689 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004690 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004691 client.
4692
4693 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4694 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4695 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4696
4697 Example :
4698 # remove the Server header from responses
4699 reqidel ^Server:.*
4700
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004701 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4702 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004703
4704
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004705rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4706rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004707 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 no | yes | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4712 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4713 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4714 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4715 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4716 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4717 ignores case.
4718
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004719 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4720 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4721
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004722 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4723 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4724 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4725 case-sensitive.
4726
4727 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004728 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4729 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4730 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004731
4732 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4733 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4734
4735 Example :
4736 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4737 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4738
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004739 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4740 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004741
4742
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004743rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4744rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004745 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 no | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments :
4749 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4750 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4751 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4752 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4753 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4754 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4755 ignores case.
4756
4757 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4758 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4759 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4760 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004761 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004762
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004763 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4764 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4765
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004766 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4767 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4768 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4769
4770 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4771 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4772 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4773 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4774 are not case-sensitive.
4775
4776 Example :
4777 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4778 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4779
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004780 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4781 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004782
4783
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004784server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004785 Declare a server in a backend
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 no | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments :
4789 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004790 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004791 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004792
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004793 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4794 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4795 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4796 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004797 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4798 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4799 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4800 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4801 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4802 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004804 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004805 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4806 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4807 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4808 adding this value to the client's port.
4809
4810 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4811 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004812 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004813
4814 Examples :
4815 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4816 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4817
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004818 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4819 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004820
4821
4822source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004823source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004824source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004825 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | no | yes | yes
4828 Arguments :
4829 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4830 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4831 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4832 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4833
4834 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4835 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004836 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4837 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4838 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004839
4840 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4841 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4842 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4843 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4844 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4845 <addr>.
4846
4847 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4848 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4849 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4850 port.
4851
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004852 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4853 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4854 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4855 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4856 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4857 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4858 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4859 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4860 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4861 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4862 HTTP header.
4863
4864 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4865 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004866 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004867 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4868 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4869 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4870 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4871 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4872 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4873 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4874
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004875 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4876 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4877 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4878 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4879 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4880 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4881
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004882 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4883 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4884 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4885 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4886
4887 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4888 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4889 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4890 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4891 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4892 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4893
4894 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4895 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4896 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4897 there are two methods :
4898
4899 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4900 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4901 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4902 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4903 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4904 of the client ranges may be used.
4905
4906 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4907 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4908 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4909 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4910 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4911 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4912 same session.
4913
4914 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4915 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4916 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4917 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4918 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4919 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4920
4921 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4922 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4923 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004924 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004925
4926 Examples :
4927 backend private
4928 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4929 source 192.168.1.200
4930
4931 backend transparent_ssl1
4932 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4933 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4934
4935 backend transparent_ssl2
4936 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4937 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4938 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4939
4940 backend transparent_ssl3
4941 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4942 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4943 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4944
4945 backend transparent_smtp
4946 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4947 # with Tproxy version 4.
4948 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4949
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004950 backend transparent_http
4951 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4952 # proxy.
4953 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004955 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004956 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004958
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004959srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4960 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4962 yes | no | yes | yes
4963 Arguments :
4964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4966 as explained at the top of this document.
4967
4968 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4969 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4970 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4971 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4972 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4973 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4974 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4975
4976 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4977 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4978 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4979 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4980 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004981 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004982 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004983 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004984
4985 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4986 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4987 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4988 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4989 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4990 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4991
4992 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4993 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4994
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004995 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
4996 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004997
4998
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004999stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5000 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 no | no | yes | yes
5003
5004 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5005 matched.
5006
5007 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5008 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5009
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005010 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5011 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5012 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5013
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005014 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5015 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5016 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5017 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005018
5019 Example :
5020 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5021 backend stats_localhost
5022 stats enable
5023 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5024
5025 Example :
5026 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5027 backend stats_auth
5028 stats enable
5029 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5030 stats admin if TRUE
5031
5032 Example :
5033 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5034 userlist stats-auth
5035 group admin users admin
5036 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5037 group readonly users haproxy
5038 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5039
5040 backend stats_auth
5041 stats enable
5042 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5043 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5044 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5045 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5046
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005047 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5048 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5049 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005050
5051
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005052stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5053 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | no | yes | yes
5056 Arguments :
5057 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5058
5059 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5060
5061 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5062 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5063 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5064 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5065 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5066 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5067
5068 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5069 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5070 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005071 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005072
5073 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5074 report using "stats scope".
5075
5076 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5077 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5078 unobvious parameters.
5079
5080 Example :
5081 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5082 backend public_www
5083 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5084 stats enable
5085 stats hide-version
5086 stats scope .
5087 stats uri /admin?stats
5088 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5089 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5090 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5091
5092 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5093 backend private_monitoring
5094 stats enable
5095 stats uri /admin?stats
5096 stats refresh 5s
5097
5098 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5099
5100
5101stats enable
5102 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | no | yes | yes
5105 Arguments : none
5106
5107 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5108 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5109 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5110 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5111 - stats auth : no authentication
5112 - stats scope : no restriction
5113
5114 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5115 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5116 unobvious parameters.
5117
5118 Example :
5119 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5120 backend public_www
5121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5122 stats enable
5123 stats hide-version
5124 stats scope .
5125 stats uri /admin?stats
5126 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5127 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5128 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5129
5130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5131 backend private_monitoring
5132 stats enable
5133 stats uri /admin?stats
5134 stats refresh 5s
5135
5136 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5137
5138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005139stats hide-version
5140 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005143 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005145 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5146 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5147 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5148 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5149 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5150 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005152 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5153 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5154 unobvious parameters.
5155
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005156 Example :
5157 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5158 backend public_www
5159 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005160 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005161 stats hide-version
5162 stats scope .
5163 stats uri /admin?stats
5164 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5165 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5166 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005167
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005168 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5169 backend private_monitoring
5170 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005171 stats uri /admin?stats
5172 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005174 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005175
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005176
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005177stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5178 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5179 Access control for statistics
5180
5181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5182 no | no | yes | yes
5183
5184 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5185 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5186 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5187 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5188 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5189 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5190
5191 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5192 instance.
5193
5194 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5195 about ACL usage.
5196
5197
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005198stats realm <realm>
5199 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | no | yes | yes
5202 Arguments :
5203 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5204 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5205 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5206
5207 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5208 using a backslash ('\').
5209
5210 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5211 only related to authentication.
5212
5213 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5214 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5215 unobvious parameters.
5216
5217 Example :
5218 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5219 backend public_www
5220 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5221 stats enable
5222 stats hide-version
5223 stats scope .
5224 stats uri /admin?stats
5225 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5226 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5227 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5228
5229 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5230 backend private_monitoring
5231 stats enable
5232 stats uri /admin?stats
5233 stats refresh 5s
5234
5235 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5236
5237
5238stats refresh <delay>
5239 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | no | yes | yes
5242 Arguments :
5243 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5244 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5245 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5246 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5247 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5248 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5249
5250 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5251 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5252 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5253 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5254
5255 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5256 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5257 unobvious parameters.
5258
5259 Example :
5260 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5261 backend public_www
5262 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5263 stats enable
5264 stats hide-version
5265 stats scope .
5266 stats uri /admin?stats
5267 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5268 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5269 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5270
5271 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5272 backend private_monitoring
5273 stats enable
5274 stats uri /admin?stats
5275 stats refresh 5s
5276
5277 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5278
5279
5280stats scope { <name> | "." }
5281 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284 Arguments :
5285 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5286 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5287 section in which the statement appears.
5288
5289 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5290 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5291 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5292 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5293 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5294 exists.
5295
5296 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5297 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5298 unobvious parameters.
5299
5300 Example :
5301 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5302 backend public_www
5303 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5304 stats enable
5305 stats hide-version
5306 stats scope .
5307 stats uri /admin?stats
5308 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5309 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5310 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5311
5312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5313 backend private_monitoring
5314 stats enable
5315 stats uri /admin?stats
5316 stats refresh 5s
5317
5318 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5319
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005320
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005321stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005322 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5324 yes | no | yes | yes
5325
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005326 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005327 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5328
5329 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5330 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5331
5332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005334 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005335
5336 Example :
5337 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5338 backend private_monitoring
5339 stats enable
5340 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5341 stats uri /admin?stats
5342 stats refresh 5s
5343
5344 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5345 global section.
5346
5347
5348stats show-legends
5349 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5350 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5351 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5352 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5353 - IP (socket, server)
5354 - cookie (backend, server)
5355
5356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005358 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005359
5360 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5361
5362
5363stats show-node [ <name> ]
5364 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | no | yes | yes
5367 Arguments:
5368 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5369 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5370
5371 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5372 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005373 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005374
5375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5377 unobvious parameters.
5378
5379 Example:
5380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5381 backend private_monitoring
5382 stats enable
5383 stats show-node Europe-1
5384 stats uri /admin?stats
5385 stats refresh 5s
5386
5387 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5388 section.
5389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005390
5391stats uri <prefix>
5392 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | no | yes | yes
5395 Arguments :
5396 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5397 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5398 query string.
5399
5400 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5401 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5402 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5403 possible to reach it in the application.
5404
5405 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005406 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005407 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5408 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5409 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5410 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5411
5412 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5413 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5414 an address or a port to statistics only.
5415
5416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5418 unobvious parameters.
5419
5420 Example :
5421 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5422 backend public_www
5423 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5424 stats enable
5425 stats hide-version
5426 stats scope .
5427 stats uri /admin?stats
5428 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5429 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5430 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5431
5432 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5433 backend private_monitoring
5434 stats enable
5435 stats uri /admin?stats
5436 stats refresh 5s
5437
5438 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5439
5440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005441stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5442 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005444 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005445
5446 Arguments :
5447 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5448 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5449 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5450 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5451
5452 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5453 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5454 the "stick-table" statement.
5455
5456 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5457 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5458 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5459 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5460 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5461
5462 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5463 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5464 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5465 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5466 transformation rules.
5467
5468 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5469 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5470 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5471 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5472 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5473 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5474 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5475
5476 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5477 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5478 ACL based conditions.
5479
5480 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5481 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5482 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5483 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5484
5485 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5486 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5487 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5488 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005490 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5491 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5492 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005494 Example :
5495 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5496 # last 30 minutes
5497 backend pop
5498 mode tcp
5499 balance roundrobin
5500 stick store-request src
5501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5502 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5503 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5504
5505 backend smtp
5506 mode tcp
5507 balance roundrobin
5508 stick match src table pop
5509 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5510 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005512 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5513 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005514
5515
5516stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5517 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 no | no | yes | yes
5520
5521 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5522 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5523 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5524 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005526 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5527 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5528 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5529
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005530 Examples :
5531 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005532 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005533
5534 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5535 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5536 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5537
5538
5539 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5540 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5541 backend http
5542 mode http
5543 balance roundrobin
5544 stick on src table https
5545 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5546 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5547 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5548
5549 backend https
5550 mode tcp
5551 balance roundrobin
5552 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5553 stick on src
5554 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5555 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005557 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005558
5559
5560stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5561 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 no | no | yes | yes
5564
5565 Arguments :
5566 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5567 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5568 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5569 server is selected.
5570
5571 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5572 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5573 the "stick-table" statement.
5574
5575 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5576 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5577 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5578 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5579 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5580 address.
5581
5582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5584 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5585 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5586 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5587 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5588 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5589 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5590 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5591 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5592
5593 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5594 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5595 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5596 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5597 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5598 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5599 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5600
5601 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5602 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5603 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5604 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5605
5606 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5607 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5608 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5609 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5610 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5611 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5612 another protocol or access method.
5613
5614 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5615 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5616 the request.
5617
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005618 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5619 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5620 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5621
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005622 Example :
5623 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5624 # last 30 minutes
5625 backend pop
5626 mode tcp
5627 balance roundrobin
5628 stick store-request src
5629 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5630 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5631 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5632
5633 backend smtp
5634 mode tcp
5635 balance roundrobin
5636 stick match src table pop
5637 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5638 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5639
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005640 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5641 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005642
5643
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005644stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005645 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5646 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005647 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005649 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005650
5651 Arguments :
5652 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5653 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5654 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5655 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5656
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005657 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5658 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5659 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5660 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005662 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5663 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5664 instance.
5665
5666 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5667 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5668 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5669 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5670 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5671 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005672 to 32 characters.
5673
5674 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5675 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5676 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5677 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5678 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5679 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005680
5681 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005682 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5683 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005684 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5685 increase.
5686
5687 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005688 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5689 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5690 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005691
5692 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5693 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5694 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5695 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5696 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5697 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5698 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5699 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5700 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5701 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5702 parameter (see below).
5703
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005704 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5705 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5706 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5707 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5708 soft restart.
5709
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005710 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5711
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005712 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5713 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5714 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5715 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5716 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005717 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005718 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5719 if not expiration delay is specified.
5720
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005721 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5722 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5723 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5724 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005725 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5726 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5727 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5728 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5729 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5730 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5731 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5732 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5733 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5734 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5735 types and their arguments.
5736
5737 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5738 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5739 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5740 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5741
5742 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5743 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5744 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5745 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5746
5747 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5748 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5749 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5750 they were received.
5751
5752 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5753 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5754 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5755 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5756 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5757
5758 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5759 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5760 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5761 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5762 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5763
5764 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5765 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5766 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5767
5768 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5769 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5770 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5771 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5772 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5773
5774 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5775 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5776 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5777 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5778 the client side.
5779
5780 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5783 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5784 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5785 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5786 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5787
5788 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5789 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5790 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5791 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5792 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5793 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5794 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5795
5796 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5797 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5799 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5800 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5801 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5802
5803 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5804 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5805 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5806 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5807
5808 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5811 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5812 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5813 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5814 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5815 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5816 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5817 recommended for better fairness.
5818
5819 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5820 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5821 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5822 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5823
5824 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5825 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5826 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5827 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5828 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5829 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5830 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5831 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5832 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5833 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005834
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005835 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5836 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005837 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5838 reference it.
5839
5840 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5841 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5842 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5843 as an exclusive stickiness.
5844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005845 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5846 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5847 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5848 something that can be ignored.
5849
5850 Example:
5851 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5852 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5853 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5854 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5855
5856 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005857 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005858
5859
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005860stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5861 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 no | no | yes | yes
5864
5865 Arguments :
5866 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5867 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5868 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5869 server is selected.
5870
5871 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5872 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5873 the "stick-table" statement.
5874
5875 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5876 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5877 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5878 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5879
5880 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5881 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5882 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5883 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5884 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5885 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005886 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005887 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5888 rules.
5889
5890 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5891 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5892 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5893 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5894 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5895 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5896 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5897
5898 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5899 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5900 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5901 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5902
5903 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5904 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5905 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5906 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5907 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5908 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5909 another protocol or access method.
5910
5911 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5912
5913 Example :
5914 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5915 backend https
5916 mode tcp
5917 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005918 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005919 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005920
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005921 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5922 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5923
5924 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5926 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5927
5928 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5929 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005930
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005931 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5932 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5933 # at offset 44.
5934
5935 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5936 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5937
5938 # Learn on response if server hello.
5939 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005940
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005941 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5942 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5943
5944 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5945 extraction.
5946
5947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005948tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5949 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005952 Arguments :
5953 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5954 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5955 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005957 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005958
5959 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5960 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005961 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5962 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5963 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5964 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5965 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5966 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005968 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5969 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5970 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5971 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 Three types of actions are supported :
5974 - accept :
5975 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5976 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5977 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005979 - reject :
5980 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5981 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5982 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5983 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5984 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5985 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5986 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5987 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5988 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5989 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5990 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5991 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5994 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5995 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5996 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5997 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5998 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5999 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6000 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6001 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006003 These actions take one or two arguments :
6004 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6005 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6006 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006008 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6009 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6010 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6011 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006013 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6014 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6015 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6016 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6017 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006024 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6025 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6026 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6029 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6030 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006033 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6037 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6038 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6041 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6042 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
6044 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
6048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006049tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6050 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006052 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006053 Arguments :
6054 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6055 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6056 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6061 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6062 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6063 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6064 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006066 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6067 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6068 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6069 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6070 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6071 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6072 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6073 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6074 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006076 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6077 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6078 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6079 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006081 Three types of actions are supported :
6082 - accept :
6083 - reject :
6084 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006086 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6087 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006089 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6090 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6091 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6092 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6093 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6094 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006096 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6098 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006100 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006101 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6102 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6103 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6104 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6105 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006106
6107 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006108 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6109 # and reject everything else.
6110 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6111 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006112 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 tcp-request content reject
6114
6115 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006116 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6117 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6118 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006119 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006120
6121 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6122 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6123 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006124 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 tcp-request content reject
6126
6127 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6128 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6129
6130 frontend http
6131 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6132 # protecting all our sites
6133 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6134 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6135 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6136 ...
6137 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6138
6139 backend http_dynamic
6140 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6141 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6142 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6143 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6144 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6145 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6146 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006148 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006150 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006151
6152
6153tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6154 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006156 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006157 Arguments :
6158 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6159 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6160 as explained at the top of this document.
6161
6162 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6163 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6164 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6165 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6166 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6167
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006168 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6169 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6170 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6171 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6172
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006173 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6174 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006175 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006176 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006177 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6178 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6179 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6180 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006181
6182 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6183 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6184 it pass through unaffected.
6185
6186 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6187 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6188 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006189 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006190 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6191 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006192 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6193 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6194 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006196 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006197 "timeout client".
6198
6199
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006200tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6201 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 no | no | yes | yes
6204 Arguments :
6205 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6206 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6207 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6208
6209 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6210
6211 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6212 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6213 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6214 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006215 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006216
6217 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6218
6219 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6220 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6221 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6222 inserted.
6223
6224 Two types of actions are supported :
6225 - accept :
6226 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6227 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6228 the rules evaluation.
6229
6230 - reject :
6231 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6232 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006233 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006234
6235 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6236 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6237 for changing the default action to a reject.
6238
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006239 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6240 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6241 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6242 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006243 period.
6244
6245 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6246
6247 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6248
6249
6250tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6251 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 no | no | yes | yes
6254 Arguments :
6255 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6257 as explained at the top of this document.
6258
6259 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6260
6261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006262timeout check <timeout>
6263 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6264 established.
6265
6266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6267 yes | no | yes | yes
6268 Arguments:
6269 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6270 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6271 as explained at the top of this document.
6272
6273 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6274 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6275 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6276 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006277 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6278 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6279 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006280
6281 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6282 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6283
6284 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6285 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006286 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006287
6288 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6289 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6290 forget about it.
6291
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006292 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6293 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006294
6295
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006296timeout client <timeout>
6297timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6298 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6300 yes | yes | yes | no
6301 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6304 as explained at the top of this document.
6305
6306 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6307 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6308 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6309 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6310 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6311 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6312 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6313 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006314 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006315 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006316 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6317 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6318 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006319
6320 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6321 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6322 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6323 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6324 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6325 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6326
6327 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6328 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6329 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6330
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006331 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006332
6333
6334timeout connect <timeout>
6335timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6336 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6338 yes | no | yes | yes
6339 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006340 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006341 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6342 as explained at the top of this document.
6343
6344 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006345 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006346 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006347 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006348 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6349 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006350
6351 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6352 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6353 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6354 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6355 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6356 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6357
6358 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6359 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6360 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6361
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006362 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6363 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006364
6365
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006366timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6367 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 yes | yes | yes | yes
6370 Arguments :
6371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6373 as explained at the top of this document.
6374
6375 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6376 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6377 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6378 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6379 once the request has started to present itself.
6380
6381 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6382 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6383 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6384 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6385 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6386
6387 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6388 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6389 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6390 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6391
6392 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6393 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6394 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6395 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6396 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006397 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006398
6399 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6400 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6401 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6402 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6403
6404 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6405
6406
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006407timeout http-request <timeout>
6408 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006410 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6414 as explained at the top of this document.
6415
6416 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6417 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6418 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6419 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6420 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6421 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6422 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6423 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6424
6425 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6426 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006427 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6428 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006429
6430 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6431 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6432 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6433 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6434 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6435
6436 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006437 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6438 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6439 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006440
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006441 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006442
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006443
6444timeout queue <timeout>
6445 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | no | yes | yes
6448 Arguments :
6449 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6450 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6451 as explained at the top of this document.
6452
6453 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6454 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6455 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6456 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6457 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6458
6459 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6460 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6461 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6462 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6463
6464 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6465
6466
6467timeout server <timeout>
6468timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6469 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6471 yes | no | yes | yes
6472 Arguments :
6473 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6474 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6475 as explained at the top of this document.
6476
6477 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6478 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6479 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6480 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6481 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6482 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6483 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6484
6485 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6486 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6487 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6488 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6489 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006490 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006491 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006492 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6493 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6494 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6495 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006496
6497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6498 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6499 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6500 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6501 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6502 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6503
6504 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6505 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6506 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6507
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006508 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006509
6510
6511timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006512 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6514 yes | yes | yes | yes
6515 Arguments :
6516 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6517 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6518 as explained at the top of this document.
6519
6520 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6521 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6522 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6523
6524 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6525 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6526 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6527 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006528 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006529
6530 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6531
6532
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006533timeout tunnel <timeout>
6534 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | no | yes | yes
6537 Arguments :
6538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6540 as explained at the top of this document.
6541
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006542 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006543 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6544 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6545 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6546 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6547 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6548 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6549 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6550 specified.
6551
6552 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6553 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6554 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6555 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6556 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6557
6558 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6559 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6560 forget about it.
6561
6562 Example :
6563 defaults http
6564 option http-server-close
6565 timeout connect 5s
6566 timeout client 30s
6567 timeout client 30s
6568 timeout server 30s
6569 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6570
6571 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6572
6573
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006574transparent (deprecated)
6575 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006578 Arguments : none
6579
6580 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6581 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6582 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6583 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6584 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6585 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6586 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6587 appropriate server.
6588
6589 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6590
6591 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6592 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6593
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006594 See also: "option transparent"
6595
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006596unique-id-format <string>
6597 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | yes | yes | no
6600 Arguments :
6601 <string> is a log-format string.
6602
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006603 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6604 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6605 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6606 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006607
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006608 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6609 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6610 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6611 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6612 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6613 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6614 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6615 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006617 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6618 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006619
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006620 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006621
6622 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6623
6624 will generate:
6625
6626 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6627
6628 See also: "unique-id-header"
6629
6630unique-id-header <name>
6631 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | yes | yes | no
6634 Arguments :
6635 <name> is the name of the header.
6636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006637 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6638 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006640 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006641
6642 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6643 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6644
6645 will generate:
6646
6647 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6648
6649 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006650
6651use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6652use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006653 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6655 no | yes | yes | no
6656 Arguments :
6657 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006659 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006660
6661 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6662 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6663 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006664 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6665 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6666 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6667 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006668
6669 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6670 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6671 assign the backend.
6672
6673 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6674 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6675 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6676 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6677 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6678 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6679
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006680 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006681 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006682 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6683 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6684 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6685
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006686 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006687
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006688
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006689use-server <server> if <condition>
6690use-server <server> unless <condition>
6691 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 no | no | yes | yes
6694 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006695 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006696
6697 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6698
6699 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6700 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6701 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6702
6703 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6704 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6705 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6706 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6707 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6708 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6709 matches will assign the server.
6710
6711 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6712 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6713 with the next rules until one matches.
6714
6715 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6716 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6717 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6718 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6719
6720 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6721 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6722 stripped.
6723
6724 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6725 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6726 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6727 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6728
6729 Example :
6730 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6731 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6732 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6733 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6734 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6735 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6736 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6737 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6738 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6739
6740 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006742
67435. Bind and Server options
6744--------------------------
6745
6746The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6747depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6748settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6749written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6750described in this section.
6751
6752
67535.1. Bind options
6754-----------------
6755
6756The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6757as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6758no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6759parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6760while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6761provided immediately after the setting name.
6762
6763The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6764
6765accept-proxy
6766 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6767 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6768 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6769 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6770 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6771 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6772 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6773 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6774 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6775 usable.
6776
6777backlog <backlog>
6778 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6779 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6780
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006781ecdhe <named curve>
6782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6783 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6784 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6785
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006786ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6788 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6789 client's certificate.
6790
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006791ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6793 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6794 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6795 error is ignored.
6796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006797ciphers <ciphers>
6798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6799 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6800 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6801 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6802 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6803
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006804crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6806 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6807 to verify client's certificate.
6808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006809crt <cert>
6810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6811 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6812 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006813 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6814 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6815 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6816 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6817 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6818 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6819 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6820 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006821 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006822 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6823 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6824 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6825 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6826 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006827
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006828crt-ignore-err <errors>
6829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6830 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6831 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6832 error is ignored.
6833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006834defer-accept
6835 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6836 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6837 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6838 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6839 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6840 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6841 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6842 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6843 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6844 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6845 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6846
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006847force-sslv3
6848 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6849 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6850 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6851
6852force-tlsv10
6853 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6854 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6855
6856force-tlsv11
6857 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6858 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6859
6860force-tlsv12
6861 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6862 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6863
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006864gid <gid>
6865 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6866 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6867 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6868 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6869 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6870
6871group <group>
6872 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6873 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6874 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6875 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6876 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6877
6878id <id>
6879 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6880 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6881 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6882 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6883
6884interface <interface>
6885 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6886 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6887 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6888 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6889 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6890 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6891 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6892 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6893
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006894level <level>
6895 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6896 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6897 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6898 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6899 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6900 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6901 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6902 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6903 counters).
6904 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6905 all counters).
6906
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006907maxconn <maxconn>
6908 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6909 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6910 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6911 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6912 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6913 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6914 eat all memory.
6915
6916mode <mode>
6917 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6918 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6919 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6920 UNIX sockets.
6921
6922mss <maxseg>
6923 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6924 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6925 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6926 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6927 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6928 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6929 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6930 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6931 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6932 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6933 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6934
6935name <name>
6936 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6937 page.
6938
6939nice <nice>
6940 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6941 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6942 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6943 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6944 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6945 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6946 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6947 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6948 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6949 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6950 one for an RDP socket.
6951
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006952no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6954 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6955 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006956 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6957 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006958
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006959no-tls-tickets
6960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6961 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6962 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6963 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6964
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006965no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006967 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6968 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6969 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6970 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006971
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006972no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006973 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006974 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6975 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6976 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6977 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006978
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006979no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006981 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6982 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6983 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6984 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006985
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02006986npn <protocols>
6987 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
6988 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
6989 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
6990 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
6991 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
6992
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006993ssl
6994 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6995 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
6996 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
6997 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
6998 to deciphered contents.
6999
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007000tfo
7001 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7002 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7003 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7004 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7005 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7006 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7007 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7008 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7009 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007011transparent
7012 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7013 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7014 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7015 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7016 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7017 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7018 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7019 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7020 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7021 so check for support with your vendor.
7022
7023uid <uid>
7024 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7025 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7026 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7027 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7028 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7029
7030user <user>
7031 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7032 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7033 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7034 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7035 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7036
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007037verify [none|optional|required]
7038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7039 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7040 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7041 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7042 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007043 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7044 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7045 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7046 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007047
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020070485.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007049------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007051The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7052which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7053arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7054settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7055after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7056Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7057address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007059 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007060 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007062The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007063
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007064addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007065 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7066 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7067 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7068 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7069 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007071 Supported in default-server: No
7072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073backup
7074 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7075 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7076 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7077 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7078 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7079 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007081 Supported in default-server: No
7082
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007083ca-file <cafile>
7084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7085 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7086 server's certificate.
7087
7088 Supported in default-server: No
7089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007090check
7091 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007092 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7093 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7094 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7095 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7096 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7097 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7098 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7099 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7100 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7101 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007103 Supported in default-server: No
7104
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007105check-send-proxy
7106 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7107 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7108 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7109 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7110 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7111 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7112 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7113
7114 Supported in default-server: No
7115
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007116check-ssl
7117 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7118 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7119 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7120 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7121 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7122 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7123 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7124 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7125 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7126
7127 Supported in default-server: No
7128
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007129ciphers <ciphers>
7130 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7131 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7132 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7133 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7134 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7135 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7136 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7137 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7138
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007139 Supported in default-server: No
7140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007141cookie <value>
7142 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7143 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7144 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7145 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7146 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7147 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7148 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007150 Supported in default-server: No
7151
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007152crl-file <crlfile>
7153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7154 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7155 to verify server's certificate.
7156
7157 Supported in default-server: No
7158
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007159disabled
7160 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7161 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7162 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7163 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7164 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7165
7166 Supported in default-server: No
7167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007168error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007169 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7170 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7171 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007173 Supported in default-server: Yes
7174
7175 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007177fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007178 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7179 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7180 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007182 Supported in default-server: Yes
7183
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007184force-sslv3
7185 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7186 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7187 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7188
7189 Supported in default-server: No
7190
7191force-tlsv10
7192 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7193 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7194
7195 Supported in default-server: No
7196
7197force-tlsv11
7198 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7199 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7200
7201 Supported in default-server: No
7202
7203force-tlsv12
7204 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7205 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7206
7207 Supported in default-server: No
7208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007210 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7211 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7212 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007214 Supported in default-server: No
7215
7216inter <delay>
7217fastinter <delay>
7218downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007219 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7220 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7221 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7222 between checks depending on the server state :
7223
7224 Server state | Interval used
7225 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7226 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7227 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7228 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7229 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7230 or yet unchecked. |
7231 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7232 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7233 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007235 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7236 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7237 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7238 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7239 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7240 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7241 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7242 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7243 servers.
7244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007245 Supported in default-server: Yes
7246
7247maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007248 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7249 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7250 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7251 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7252 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7253 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7254 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7255 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007257 Supported in default-server: Yes
7258
7259maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007260 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7261 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7262 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7263 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7264 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7265 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7266 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007268 Supported in default-server: Yes
7269
7270minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007271 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7272 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7273 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7274 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7275 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7276 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007277 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007278 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007280 Supported in default-server: Yes
7281
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007282no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007283 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7284 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007285 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007286
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007287 Supported in default-server: No
7288
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007289no-tls-tickets
7290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7291 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7292 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7293 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7294
7295 Supported in default-server: No
7296
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007297no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007298 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007299 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7300 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007301 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7302 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007303
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007304 Supported in default-server: No
7305
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007306no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007307 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007308 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7309 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007310 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7311 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007312
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007313 Supported in default-server: No
7314
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007315no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007316 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007317 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7318 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007319 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7320 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007321
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007322 Supported in default-server: No
7323
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007324non-stick
7325 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7326 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7327 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7328
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007329 Supported in default-server: No
7330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007331observe <mode>
7332 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7333 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7334 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7335 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7336 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7337 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007338 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007340 Supported in default-server: No
7341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007342 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007344on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007345 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7346 Currently, four modes are available:
7347 - fastinter: force fastinter
7348 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7349 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7350 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7351 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007353 Supported in default-server: Yes
7354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007355 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7356
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007357on-marked-down <action>
7358 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7359 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007360 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7361 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7362 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7363 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7364 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7365 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7366 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7367 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007368
7369 Actions are disabled by default
7370
7371 Supported in default-server: Yes
7372
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007373on-marked-up <action>
7374 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7375 Currently one action is available:
7376 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7377 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7378 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7379 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7380 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7381 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7382 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7383 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7384
7385 Actions are disabled by default
7386
7387 Supported in default-server: Yes
7388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007389port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007390 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7391 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7392 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7393 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7394 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7395 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007397 Supported in default-server: Yes
7398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007399redir <prefix>
7400 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7401 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7402 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7403 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7404 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7405 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7406 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7407 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007408 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007409 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7410 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7411 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7412 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7413 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7414
7415 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007417 Supported in default-server: No
7418
7419rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007420 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7421 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7422 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007424 Supported in default-server: Yes
7425
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007426send-proxy
7427 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7428 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7429 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7430 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7431 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7432 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7433 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7434 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7435 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007436 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7437 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7438 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7439 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7440 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007441
7442 Supported in default-server: No
7443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007444slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007445 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7446 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7447 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7448 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7449 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7450 parameters :
7451
7452 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7453 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7454
7455 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7456 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7457 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7458 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7459
7460 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7461 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7462 seen as failed.
7463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007464 Supported in default-server: Yes
7465
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007466source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007467source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007468source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007469 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7470 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7471 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7472 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7473
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007474 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7475 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7476 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7477 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7478 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7479 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7480 server.
7481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007482 Supported in default-server: No
7483
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007484ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007485 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7486 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7487 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7488 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7489 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7490 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7491 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7492 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7493
7494 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007496track [<proxy>/]<server>
7497 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7498 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7499 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7500 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7501 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007503 Supported in default-server: No
7504
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007505verify [none|required]
7506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7507 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7508 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7509 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7510 is aborted.
7511
7512 Supported in default-server: No
7513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007514weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007515 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7516 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7517 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007518 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7519 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7520 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7521 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7522 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7523 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007525 Supported in default-server: Yes
7526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007527
75286. HTTP header manipulation
7529---------------------------
7530
7531In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7532response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7533request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7534which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7535against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7536to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7537passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7538headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7539never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7540
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007541There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7542(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7543rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7544messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7545in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007546happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007547add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7548normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007550This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7551in section 4.2 :
7552
7553 - reqadd <string>
7554 - reqallow <search>
7555 - reqiallow <search>
7556 - reqdel <search>
7557 - reqidel <search>
7558 - reqdeny <search>
7559 - reqideny <search>
7560 - reqpass <search>
7561 - reqipass <search>
7562 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7563 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7564 - reqtarpit <search>
7565 - reqitarpit <search>
7566 - rspadd <string>
7567 - rspdel <search>
7568 - rspidel <search>
7569 - rspdeny <search>
7570 - rspideny <search>
7571 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7572 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7573
7574With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7575is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7576parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7577prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7578Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7579
7580 \t for a tab
7581 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7582 \n for a new line (LF)
7583 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7584 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7585 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7586 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7587 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7588
7589The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7590portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7591above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7592regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
75939 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7594is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7595
7596The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7597after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7598
7599Notes related to these keywords :
7600---------------------------------
7601 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7602 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7603 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7604
7605 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7606 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7607 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7608
7609 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7610 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7611 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7612 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7613 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7614
7615 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7616 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7617 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7618 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7619 useless headers before adding new ones.
7620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007621 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007622 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7623
7624 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7625 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7626 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7627
7628 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7629 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007630 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007631
7632
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010076337. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7634------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007635
7636The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7637content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7638from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7639simple :
7640
7641 - define test criteria with sets of values
7642 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7643
7644The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7645
7646In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7647
7648 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7649
7650This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7651Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7652and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7653an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7654of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7655
7656ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7657'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7658which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7659
7660There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7661performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7662
7663The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7664
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007665 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7666 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007667 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7668
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007669The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7670specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7671possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007672multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7673be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7674needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7675space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7676match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7677lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7678duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007679to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007680instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007681
7682 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7683
7684In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7685the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7686case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7687too.
7688
7689Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7690a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7691ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7692
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007693Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007695 - integers or integer ranges
7696 - strings
7697 - regular expressions
7698 - IP addresses and networks
7699
7700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077017.1. Matching integers
7702----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007703
7704Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7705that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7706expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7707may be omitted.
7708
7709For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7710unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7711representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7712
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007713As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7714two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7715instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7716ranges and operators.
7717
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007718For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007719operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7720Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7721of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007723Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007724
7725 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7726 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7727 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7728 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7729 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007731For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007732
7733 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7734
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007735This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7736
7737 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077407.2. Matching strings
7741---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007742
7743String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7744exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7745characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7746string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7747to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007748before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007749
7750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077517.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7752-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007753
7754Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7755they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7756possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7757passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7758the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007759the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7760match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007761
7762
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020077637.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007764----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007765
7766IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7767netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7768within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007769host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007770difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7771at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7772does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7773parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007774
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007775IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7776Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7777trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7778IPv6 patterns.
7779
7780HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7781following situations :
7782 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7783 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7784 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7785 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7786 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7787 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7788 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7789 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7790 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7791 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077947.5. Available matching criteria
7795--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077977.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7798------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007799
7800A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7801analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007802addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007804always_false
7805 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7806 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7807
7808always_true
7809 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7810 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007812avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007813avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007814 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7815 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7816 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7817 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7818 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7819 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7820 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7821 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7822 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7823 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7824 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007825
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007826be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007827be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007828 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7829 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7830 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7831 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7832 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007833
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007834be_id <integer>
7835 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7836 backend it was called.
7837
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007838be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007839be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007840 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7841 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7842 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7843 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7844 sucking of an online dictionary).
7845
7846 Example :
7847 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7848 backend dynamic
7849 mode http
7850 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7851 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007852
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007853connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007854connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007855 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007856 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007857 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007859 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7860 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007861
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007862 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007863 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7864 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7865 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7866 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7867 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007868 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007869
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007870 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7871 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7872 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7873 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007874
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007875dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007876 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7877 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007879dst_conn <integer>
7880 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7881 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7882 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7883 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7884 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7885 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7886
7887dst_port <integer>
7888 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7889 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7890
7891fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007892fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007893 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7894 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7895 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7896 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7897 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7898 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7899 criteria.
7900
7901fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007902 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007903 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007904
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007905fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007906fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007907 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7908 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7909 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7910 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7911 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7912 the rate to go down below the limit.
7913
7914 Example :
7915 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7916 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7917 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7918 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7919 frontend mail
7920 bind :25
7921 mode tcp
7922 maxconn 100
7923 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7924 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7925 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7926 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007927
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007928nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007929nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007930 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7931 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7932 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7933 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7934 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007935
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007936queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007937queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007938 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7939 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7940 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7941 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7942 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7943 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7944 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007946sc1_bytes_in_rate
7947sc2_bytes_in_rate
7948 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7949 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7950 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7951
7952sc1_bytes_out_rate
7953sc2_bytes_out_rate
7954 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7955 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7956 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7957
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007958sc1_clr_gpc0
7959sc2_clr_gpc0
7960 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7961 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7962 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7963 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7964 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7965 was verified :
7966
7967 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7968 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7969 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7970 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7971 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7972 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7973 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007975sc1_conn_cnt
7976sc2_conn_cnt
7977 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7978 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7979
7980sc1_conn_cur
7981sc2_conn_cur
7982 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7983 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7984 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7985
7986sc1_conn_rate
7987sc2_conn_rate
7988 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7989 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7990 See also src_conn_rate.
7991
7992sc1_get_gpc0
7993sc2_get_gpc0
7994 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7995 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7996
7997sc1_http_err_cnt
7998sc2_http_err_cnt
7999 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8000 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8001 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8002
8003sc1_http_err_rate
8004sc2_http_err_rate
8005 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8006 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8007 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8008 src_http_err_rate.
8009
8010sc1_http_req_cnt
8011sc2_http_req_cnt
8012 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8013 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8014 src_http_req_cnt.
8015
8016sc1_http_req_rate
8017sc2_http_req_rate
8018 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8019 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8020 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8021 src_http_req_rate.
8022
8023sc1_inc_gpc0
8024sc2_inc_gpc0
8025 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8026 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8027 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8028 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8029 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8030 when a first ACL was verified :
8031
8032 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8033 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8034 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8035
8036sc1_kbytes_in
8037sc2_kbytes_in
8038 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8039 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8040 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8041 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8042
8043sc1_kbytes_out
8044sc2_kbytes_out
8045 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8046 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8047 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8048 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8049
8050sc1_sess_cnt
8051sc2_sess_cnt
8052 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8053 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8054 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8055 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008056 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008057 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8058
8059sc1_sess_rate
8060sc2_sess_rate
8061 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8062 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8063 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8064 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8065 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008066 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008067
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008068so_id <integer>
8069 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8070
8071src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008072 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8073 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8074 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008076src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008077src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008078 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8079 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8080 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008081 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008082
8083src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008084src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008085 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8086 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8087 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008088 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008089
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008090src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8091src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8092 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8093 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8094 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8095 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8096 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8097 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8098
8099 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8100 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8101 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8102 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8103 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8104 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8105 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8106
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008107src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008108src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008109 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8110 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8111 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008112 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008113
8114src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008115src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008116 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8117 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8118 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008119 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008120
8121src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008122src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008123 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8124 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8125 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008126 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008127
8128src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008129src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008130 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8131 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8132 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008133 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008134
8135src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008136src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008137 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8138 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8139 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008140 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008141
8142src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008143src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008144 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8145 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8146 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8147 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008148 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008149
8150src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008151src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008152 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8153 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8154 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008155 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008156
8157src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008158src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008159 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8160 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8161 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8162 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008163 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008164
8165src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008166src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008167 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8168 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8169 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8170 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8171 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8172 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8173
8174 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8175 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008176 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008177
8178src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008179src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008180 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8181 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8182 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8183 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008184 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008185
8186src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008187src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008188 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8189 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8190 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8191 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008192 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008194src_port <integer>
8195 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008196
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008197src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008198src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008199 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8200 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8201 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8202 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008203 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008204
8205src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008206src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008207 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8208 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8209 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8210 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008211 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008212
8213src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008214src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008215 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008216 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8217 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008218 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8219 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8220 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008222
8223 Example :
8224 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8225 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8226 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8227 listen ssh
8228 bind :22
8229 mode tcp
8230 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008231 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008232 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8233 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8234
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008235srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008236 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8237 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8238 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8239 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8240
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008241srv_id <integer>
8242 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8243
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008244srv_is_up(<server>)
8245srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8246 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8247 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8248 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8249 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8250 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8251 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8252 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8253 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8254
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008255table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008256table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008257 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8258 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8259
8260table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008261table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008262 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8263 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8264 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020082677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8268---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008269
8270A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8271during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008272through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8273keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008274
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008275rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8276 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8277 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8278 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008279 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8280 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8281 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008282
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008283req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008284 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008285 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8286 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8287 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8288 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8289 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8290 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8291
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008292req_proto_http
8293 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8294 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008295 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008296 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8297 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8298
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008299req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008300req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008301 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8302 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8303 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8304 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8305 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8306 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8307 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8308 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8309
8310req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008311req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008312 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8313 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8314 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8315 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8316 cookies.
8317
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008318req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8319 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8320 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8321 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008322 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8323 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8324 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008325
8326req_ssl_sni <string>
8327 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8328 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8329 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8330 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8331 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8332 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8333 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008334 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8335 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008336 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008337 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008338
8339 Examples :
8340 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8341 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8342 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8343 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8344 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8345
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008346req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8347 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8348 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8349 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8350 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8351 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8352 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008353 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8354 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008355 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008356 option.
8357
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008358ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8359 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8360 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8361 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8362 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8363 during this verification process.
8364
8365ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8366 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8367 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8368 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8369 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8370
8371ssl_c_err <integer>
8372 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8373 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8374 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8375 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8376
8377ssl_c_verify <integer>
8378 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8379 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8380 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8381
8382ssl_fc
8383 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8384 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8385 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8386
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008387ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8388 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8389 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8390
8391ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8392 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8393 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8394
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008395ssl_fc_has_crt
8396 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8397 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8398
8399ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008400 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008401 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8402 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8403 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8404 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008405
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008406ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008407 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8408 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8409 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8410 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008411 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8412 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8413 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008414
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008415ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8416 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8417 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8418
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008419ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008420 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8421 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8422 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8423 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008424 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8425 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008426 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8427 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8428 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008429
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008430ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008431 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8432 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8433 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8434 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008435 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8436 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8437 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8438 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008439
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008440ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008441 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8442 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8443 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8444 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008445 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8446 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8447 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8448 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008449
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008450ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8451 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8452 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8453
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008454wait_end
8455 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8456 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8457 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8458 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8459 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8460 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8461 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8462 inspection.
8463
8464 Examples :
8465 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8466 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8467 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8468
8469 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8470 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8471 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8472 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8473 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8474 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8475 tcp-request content reject
8476
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084787.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8479--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008480
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008481A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008482application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8483read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8484than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8485
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008486base <string>
8487 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8488 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8489 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8490 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8491 See also "path" and "uri".
8492
8493base_beg <string>
8494 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8495 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8496 "path_beg".
8497
8498base_dir <string>
8499 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8500 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8501 "path_dir" instead.
8502
8503base_dom <string>
8504 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8505 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8506 instead.
8507
8508base_end <string>
8509 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8510 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8511
8512base_len <integer>
8513 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8514 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8515
8516base_reg <regex>
8517 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8518 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8519 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8520 and all "base_" criteria.
8521
8522base_sub <string>
8523 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8524 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8525 also "base_dir".
8526
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008527cook(<name>) <string>
8528 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8529 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8530 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8531 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8532 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8533 sent by the server.
8534
8535 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8536 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8537 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8538
8539 cook(profile) silver gold
8540
8541cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8542 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8543 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8544 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8545
8546cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8547 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8548 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8549 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8550 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8551 server.
8552
8553cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8554 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8555 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8556 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8557 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8558 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8559
8560cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8561 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8562 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8563 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8564 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8565
8566cook_end(<name>) <string>
8567 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8568 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8569 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8570
8571cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8572 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8573 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8574 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8575 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8576 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8577
8578cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8579 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8580 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8581 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8582 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8583 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8584
8585cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8586 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8587 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8588 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8589
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008590cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8591 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8592 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8593 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8594 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8595 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8596
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008597hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008598hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008599 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8600 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8601 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8602 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008603 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8604 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8605 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8606 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8607 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008608
8609 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008610 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008611 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8612
8613 hdr(Connection) -i close
8614
8615hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008616hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008617 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8618 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8619 response headers sent by the server.
8620
8621hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008622hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8624 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8625 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8626 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8627 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8628 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8629 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8630
8631hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008632hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008633 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8634 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8635 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8636 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8637 headers sent by the server.
8638
8639hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008640hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008641 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8642 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8643 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8644 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8645 server.
8646
8647hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008648hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008649 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8650 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8651 response headers sent by the server.
8652
8653hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008654hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8655 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8656 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8657 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008658 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8659
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008660hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008661hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008662 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8663 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8664 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8665 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8666
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008667hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008668hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008669 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008670 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8671 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8672 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8673 response headers sent by the server.
8674
8675hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008676hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008677 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8678 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8679 response headers sent by the server.
8680
8681hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008682hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008683 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8684 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8685 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8686 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8687
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008688http_auth(<userlist>)
8689http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008690 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8691 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8692 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8693 of specified groups.
8694
8695 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8696
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008697http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008698 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8699 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8700 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8701 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008703method <string>
8704 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8705 already check for most common methods.
8706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008707path <string>
8708 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8709 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8710 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8711
8712path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008713 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8714 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008716path_dir <string>
8717 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8718 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8719 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8720 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8721
8722path_dom <string>
8723 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8724 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8725 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8726
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008727path_end <string>
8728 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8729 control file name extension.
8730
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008731path_len <integer>
8732 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8733 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008735path_reg <regex>
8736 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8737 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8738 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8739
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008740path_sub <string>
8741 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8742 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8743 "path_dir".
8744
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008745payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8746 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8747 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8748 strings.
8749
8750payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8751 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8752 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8753 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8754 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8755 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8756
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008757req_ver <string>
8758 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8759 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8760
8761status <integer>
8762 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8763 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8764 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8765
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008766url <string>
8767 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008768 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008769
8770url_beg <string>
8771 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008772 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8773 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008774
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008775url_dir <string>
8776 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8777 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8778 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8779 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8780
8781url_dom <string>
8782 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8783 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8784 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8785
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786url_end <string>
8787 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8788 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008789
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008790url_ip <address>
8791 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8792 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8793 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008794
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008795url_len <integer>
8796 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8797 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8798
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008799url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008800 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8801 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008802 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008803 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008805url_reg <regex>
8806 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8807 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008808 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008809
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008810url_sub <string>
8811 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8812 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008813
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008814urlp(<name>) <string>
8815 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8816 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8817
8818 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8819 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8820
8821urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8822 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8823 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8824 protocol scheme.
8825
8826urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8827 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8828 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8829 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8830 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8831
8832urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8833 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8834 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8835 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8836 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8837
8838urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8839 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8840
8841urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008842 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8843 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008844
8845urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8846 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8847 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8848
8849urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8850 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8851 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8852 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8853 "urlp_" criteria.
8854
8855urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8856 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8857 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8858 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8859
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008860urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8861 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8862 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8863 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8864 negative data.
8865
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088677.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8868---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008870Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8871every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008872order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008874ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8875---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008876FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008877HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008878HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8879HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8881HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8882HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8883HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8884LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008885METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8886METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8887METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8888METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8889METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8890METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008891RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008892REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008893TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008894WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8895---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008896
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088987.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8899----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8902combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008904 - AND (implicit)
8905 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8906 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008908A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008910 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008912Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8913indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008915For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8916"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8917requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8918is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008920 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8921 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8922 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8923 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008925To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8926and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008928 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8929 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8930 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8931 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008933 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8934 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8935 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8936 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008937
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008938It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8939expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8940be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008941the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008942
8943 The following rule :
8944
8945 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8946 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8947
8948 Can also be written that way :
8949
8950 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8951
8952It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8953to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8954simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8955sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8956good use is the following :
8957
8958 With named ACLs :
8959
8960 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8961 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8962 monitor fail if site_dead
8963
8964 With anonymous ACLs :
8965
8966 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008969
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008970
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010089717.8. Pattern extraction
8972-----------------------
8973
8974The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8975response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8976for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8977
8978All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8979"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8980begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8981arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8982much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8983equivalent used in ACLs.
8984
8985The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8986
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008987 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8988 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8989 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8990 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8991 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8992 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8993 requested objects by host/path.
8994
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008995 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008996 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8997 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8998 according to RFC 4291.
8999
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009000 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9001 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9002 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009003 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9004 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9005 according to RFC 4291.
9006
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009007 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9008 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9009 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9010 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9011 type integer and only works with such tables.
9012
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009013 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9014 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9015 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9016 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9017 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9018 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9019 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009020 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009021
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009022 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9023 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9024 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9025 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9026 wiser to use "url" instead.
9027
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009028 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009029 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9030 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9031 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9032 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009033
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009034 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009035 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9036 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9037 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9038 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9039 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9040 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9041 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9042 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009043
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009044 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9045 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9046 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9047 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9048
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009049 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9050 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9051
9052 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9053 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9054 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9055
9056 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9057 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9058
9059 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9060 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9061 error is encountered.
9062
9063 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9064 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9065 otherwise zero.
9066
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009067 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9068 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9069 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9070
9071 ssl_fc_cipher
9072 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9073 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9074
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009075 ssl_fc_has_crt
9076 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9077 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9078
9079 ssl_fc_has_sni
9080 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009081 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9082 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009083 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009084 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009085
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009086 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009087 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9088 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9089 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9090 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009091 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009092
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009093 ssl_fc_protocol
9094 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection
9095 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9096
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009097 ssl_fc_session_id
9098 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9099 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9100 stick on a given client.
9101
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009102 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009103 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9104 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9105 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9106 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9107 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009108
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009109 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9110 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9111 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9112
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009113 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9114 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9115 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9116 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9117
9118 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9119 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9120 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9121 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9122 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9123 table for a given source address.
9124
9125 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9126 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9127
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009128 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009129 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009130 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9131 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9132 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9133 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9134 where cookies cannot be used.
9135
9136 Example :
9137 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9138 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9139 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9140 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009141
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009142 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009143 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9144 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9145 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9146 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009147
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009148 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9149 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9150 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9151 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9152 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9153 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9154 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009155
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009156 Example :
9157 listen tse-farm
9158 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9159 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9160 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9161 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9162 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9163 persist rdp-cookie
9164 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9165 # This is only useful makes sense if
9166 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9167 stick-table type string size 204800
9168 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9169 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9170 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009171
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009172 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9173 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009174
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009175 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009176 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009177 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9178 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9179 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9180 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9181 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9182 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009183
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009184 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009185
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009186 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009187 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9188 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9189 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9190
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009191 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9192 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9193 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9194 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9195 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009196
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009197 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009198
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009199
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009200The currently available list of transformations include :
9201
9202 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9203 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9204 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9205
9206 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9207 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9208 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9209
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009210 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009211 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9212 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9213 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9214 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9215
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092178. Logging
9218----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009220One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9221provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9222very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9223provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9224state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009225to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009226headers.
9227
9228In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9229about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9230send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9231
9232 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9233 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9234 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9235 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9236 at the termination.
9237
9238The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9239allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9240as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9241while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9242real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9243delay.
9244
9245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092468.1. Log levels
9247---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009248
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009249TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009250source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009251HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9252in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9253track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9254syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9255about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009256
9257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092588.2. Log formats
9259----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009260
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009261HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009262and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9263slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9264options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009265
9266 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9267 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9268 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9269 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9270 extents.
9271
9272 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9273 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9274 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9275 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9276 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9277
9278 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9279 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9280 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9281 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9282 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9283
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009284 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9285 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9286 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9287 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9288
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009289 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009291Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9292specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9293field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9294servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9295always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9296identifier.
9297
9298Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9299 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9300 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9301 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9302 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9303
9304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093058.2.1. Default log format
9306-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009307
9308This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9309as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9310format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9311
9312 Example :
9313 listen www
9314 mode http
9315 log global
9316 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9317
9318 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9319 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9320 (www/HTTP)
9321
9322 Field Format Extract from the example above
9323 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9324 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9325 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9326 4 'to' to
9327 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9328 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9329
9330Detailed fields description :
9331 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9332 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9333 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9334 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9335 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9336 and processed the connection.
9337 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9338
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009339In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9340"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9341connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9342
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009343It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9344will eventually disappear.
9345
9346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093478.2.2. TCP log format
9348---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009349
9350The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9351is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9352information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9353counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9354emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9355environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9356the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9357sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009358specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9359not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9360fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9361marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009362
9363 Example :
9364 frontend fnt
9365 mode tcp
9366 option tcplog
9367 log global
9368 default_backend bck
9369
9370 backend bck
9371 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9372
9373 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9374 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9375 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9376
9377 Field Format Extract from the example above
9378 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9379 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9380 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9381 4 frontend_name fnt
9382 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9383 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9384 7 bytes_read* 212
9385 8 termination_state --
9386 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9387 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9388
9389Detailed fields description :
9390 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009391 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9392 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9393 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9394 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9395 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009396
9397 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009398 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9399 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9400 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009401
9402 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9403 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9404 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9405 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9406
9407 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9408 and processed the connection.
9409
9410 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9411 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9412 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9413 applications.
9414
9415 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9416 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9417 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9418 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9419 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9420
9421 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9422 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9423 See "Timers" below for more details.
9424
9425 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9426 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9427 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9428 "Timers" below for more details.
9429
9430 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9431 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9432 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9433 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9434 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9435 details.
9436
9437 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9438 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9439 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9440 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9441 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9442
9443 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9444 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9445 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9446 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9447 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9448 for more details.
9449
9450 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009451 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009452 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9453 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9454 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009455 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009456
9457 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9458 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9459 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9460 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9461 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9462 caused by a denial of service attack.
9463
9464 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9465 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9466 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9467 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9468 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9469 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9470 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9471 denial of service attack.
9472
9473 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9474 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9475 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9476 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9477 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9478 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9479 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9480 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9481 be processed than on other servers.
9482
9483 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9484 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9485 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9486 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9487 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9488 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9489 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9490 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9491 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9492 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9493 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9494 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9495 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9496
9497 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9498 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9499 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9500 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9501 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9502 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9503 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9504 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9505
9506 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9507 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9508 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9509 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9510 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9511 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9512 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9513 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9514 occurs.
9515
9516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095178.2.3. HTTP log format
9518----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009519
9520The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9521is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9522the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9523are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9524emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9525generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9526"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9527which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009528frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9529is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009530
9531Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9532slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9533with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9534
9535 Example :
9536 frontend http-in
9537 mode http
9538 option httplog
9539 log global
9540 default_backend bck
9541
9542 backend static
9543 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9544
9545 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9546 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9547 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009548 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009549
9550 Field Format Extract from the example above
9551 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9552 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9553 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9554 4 frontend_name http-in
9555 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9556 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9557 7 status_code 200
9558 8 bytes_read* 2750
9559 9 captured_request_cookie -
9560 10 captured_response_cookie -
9561 11 termination_state ----
9562 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9563 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9564 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9565 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9566 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009567
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009568
9569Detailed fields description :
9570 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009571 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9572 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9573 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9574 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9575 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009576
9577 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009578 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9579 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9580 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009581
9582 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9583 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9584 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9585 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9586 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9587
9588 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9589 and processed the connection.
9590
9591 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9592 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9593 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9594
9595 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9596 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9597 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9598 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9599 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9600 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9601
9602 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9603 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9604 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9605 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9606 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9607 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9608
9609 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9610 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9611 See "Timers" below for more details.
9612
9613 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9614 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9615 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9616 below for more details.
9617
9618 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9619 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9620 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9621 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9622 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9623 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9624 for more details.
9625
9626 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9627 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9628 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9629 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9630 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9631 details.
9632
9633 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9634 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9635 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9636
9637 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9638 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9639 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9640 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9641 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9642 overflowing.
9643
9644 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9645 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9646 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9647 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9648 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9649 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9650 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9651 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9652
9653 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9654 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9655 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9656 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9657 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9658 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9659 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9660 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9661
9662 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9663 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9664 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9665 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9666 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9667 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9668 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9669
9670 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009671 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009672 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9673 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9674 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009675 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009676 system.
9677
9678 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9679 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9680 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9681 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9682 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9683 caused by a denial of service attack.
9684
9685 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9686 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9687 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9688 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9689 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9690 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9691 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9692 denial of service attack.
9693
9694 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9695 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9696 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9697 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9698 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9699 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9700 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9701 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9702 processed than on other servers.
9703
9704 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9705 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9706 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9707 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9708 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9709 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9710 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9711 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9712 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9713 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9714 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9715 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9716 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9717
9718 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9719 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9720 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9721 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9722 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9723 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9724 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9725 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9726
9727 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9728 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9729 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9730 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9731 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9732 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9733 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9734 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9735 occurs.
9736
9737 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9738 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9739 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9740 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9741 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9742 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9743 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9744 cookies" below for more details.
9745
9746 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9747 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9748 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9749 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9750 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9751 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9752 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9753 and cookies" below for more details.
9754
9755 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9756 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9757 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9758 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9759 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9760 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9761 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9762 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9763
9764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020097658.2.4. Custom log format
9766------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009767
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009768The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9769mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009770
9771HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9772Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9773separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9774prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9775
9776Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9777variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9778string formats ("Q").
9779
9780Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9781HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9782
9783Flags are :
9784 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009785 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009786
9787 Example:
9788
9789 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9790 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9791
9792At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9793
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +02009794 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009795 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009796
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009797the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009798
9799 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +02009800 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009801 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9802
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009803and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9804
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +02009805 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009806 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9807
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009808Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9809
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009810 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009811 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009812 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9813 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9814 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9815 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009816 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009817 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009818 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009819 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009820 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9821 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9822 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009823 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009824 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9825 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9826 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009827 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009828 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9829 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009830 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009831 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9832 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9833 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9834 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9835 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9836 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009837 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
9838 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
9839 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009840 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +02009841 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009842 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009843 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9844 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9845 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9846 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009847 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009848 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009849 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009850 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9851 | | %s | server_name | string |
9852 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9853 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009854 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
9855 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
9856 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009857 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009858 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009859 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009860 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009861
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +02009862 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098648.3. Advanced logging options
9865-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009866
9867Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9868just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9869options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9870for more information about their usage.
9871
9872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9874------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009875
9876It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9877haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9878commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9879monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9880ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9881
9882 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9883 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9884 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9885 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9886
9887 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9888 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9889 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9890 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9891 such as other load-balancers.
9892
9893 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9894 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9895 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9896
9897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098988.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9899----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009900
9901The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9902what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9903or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9904"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9905just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9906log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9907after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9908is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9909with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9910with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9911
9912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099138.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9914------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009915
9916Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9917for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9918"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9919retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9920raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9921a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9922file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9923you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9924"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9925
9926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099278.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9928--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009929
9930Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9931multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9932them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9933"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9934logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9935error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9936and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9937too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9938useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9939alternative.
9940
9941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099428.4. Timing events
9943------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009944
9945Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9946reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9947the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9948frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9949mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9950
9951 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9952 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9953 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9954 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9955 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9956
9957 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9958 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9959 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9960 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9961 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9962
9963 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9964 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9965 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9966 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9967 connection never established.
9968
9969 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9970 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9971 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9972 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9973 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9974 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9975 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9976 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9977 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9978 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9979 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9980
9981 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9982 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9983 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9984 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9985 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9986
9987 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9988
9989 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9990 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9991 negative.
9992
9993These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9994protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9995that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009996due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009997close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9998session has been aborted on timeout.
9999
10000Most common cases :
10001
10002 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10003 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10004 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10005 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10006 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10007 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10008 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10009 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10010 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010011 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10012 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10013 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010014
10015 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10016 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10017 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10018 of ms on remote networks.
10019
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010020 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10021 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10022 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010023
10024 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10025 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10026 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10027 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10028 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10029 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10030 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10031 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10032 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10033 to the server until another one is released.
10034
10035Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10036
10037 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10038 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10039 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10040
10041 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10042 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10043 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10044
10045 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10046 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10047 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10048 flags.
10049
10050 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10051 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10052 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10053 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10054 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10055 the client connection was maintained open.
10056
10057 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10058 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10059 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10060 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10061
10062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100638.5. Session state at disconnection
10064-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010065
10066TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10067"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
100682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10069each of which has a special meaning :
10070
10071 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10072 session to terminate :
10073
10074 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10075
10076 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10077 server explicitly refused it.
10078
10079 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10080 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10081 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10082 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10083 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10084 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10085
10086 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10087 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10088 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10089 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10090 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10091
10092 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10093 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10094 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10095 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10096 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10097
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010098 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10099 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10100
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010101 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10102 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10103 backup connections when going up.
10104
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010105 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10106
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010107 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10108 send or receive data.
10109
10110 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10111 send or receive data.
10112
10113 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10114 with nothing left in the buffers.
10115
10116 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10117
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010118 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010119 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10120
10121 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10122 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10123 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10124 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10125 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10126
10127 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10128 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10129
10130 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10131 server (HTTP only).
10132
10133 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10134
10135 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10136 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10137 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10138
10139 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10140 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10141 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10142
10143 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10144
10145 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10146 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10147
10148 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10149 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10150 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10151
10152 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10153 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010154 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10155 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010156
10157 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10158 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10159 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10160 another server.
10161
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010162 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010163 server.
10164
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010165 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10166 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10167 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10168 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10169
10170 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10171 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10172 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10173 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10174
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010175 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10176 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10177 "use-server" rule).
10178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010179 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10180
10181 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10182 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10183
10184 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10185
10186 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10187 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10188 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10189
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010190 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10191 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10192 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10193 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10194 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10195
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010196 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10197
10198 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10199 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10200
10201 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10202
10203 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10204
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010205The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10206was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010207helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10208starvation, attacks, etc...
10209
10210The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10211alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10212easier finding and understanding.
10213
10214 Flags Reason
10215
10216 -- Normal termination.
10217
10218 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10219 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10220 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10221 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10222
10223 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10224 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10225 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10226 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10227 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10228 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010230 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10231 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010232 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010233
10234 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10235 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10236 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10237
10238 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10239 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10240 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10241 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10242 the server takes too long to respond.
10243
10244 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10245 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10246 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10247 long a time to respond.
10248
10249 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10250 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10251 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10252 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10253 and the client.
10254
10255 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10256 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10257 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10258 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10259 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10260 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10261
10262 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10263 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010264 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10265 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10266 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10267 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010269 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010270 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10271 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10272 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10273 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10274 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10275
10276 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10277 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10278 503 or 504 here.
10279
10280 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10281 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10282 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10283 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10284 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10285
10286 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10287 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010288 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010289 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10290 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10291
10292 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10293 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10294 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10295 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10296 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10297 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10298 between haproxy and the server.
10299
10300 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10301 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10302 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10303 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10304 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10305 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10306 solution is to fix the application.
10307
10308 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10309 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10310 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10311 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10312 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10313 external attacks.
10314
10315 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10316 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010317 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010318 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10319 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10320
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010321 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10322 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10323 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10324 the client.
10325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010326 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10327 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10328 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10329 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010330 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10331 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10332 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10333 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10334 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010335
10336 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10337 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10338 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10339 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10340
10341 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10342 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10343 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10344 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10345
10346 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10347 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10348 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10349 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10350
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010351The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10352persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10353important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10354re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10355
10356 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10357
10358 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10359 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10360 set on a GET request.
10361
10362 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10363 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010364 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010365 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10366
10367 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10368 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10369 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10370
10371 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10372 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10373 already got a cookie.
10374
10375 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10376 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10377 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10378 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10379 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10380
10381 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10382 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10383 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10384
10385 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10386 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10387 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10388
10389 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10390 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10391
10392 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10393 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10394 then advertised in the response.
10395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103978.6. Non-printable characters
10398-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010399
10400In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10401consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10402converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10403prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10404being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10405escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10406is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10407'}' when logging headers.
10408
10409Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10410issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10411containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10412
10413Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10414the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10415performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10416
10417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104188.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10419---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010420
10421Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10422achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010423section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010424cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10425the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10426the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010427locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010428not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10429user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10430a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10431wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10432
10433 Examples :
10434 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10435 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10436
10437 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10438 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10439
10440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104418.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10442---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010443
10444Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10445proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10446the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10447server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10448
10449Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10450response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010451section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010452
10453It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010454time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10455appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010456are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10457and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10458follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10459request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10460in the logs.
10461
10462 Example :
10463 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10464 listen proxy-out
10465 mode http
10466 option httplog
10467 option logasap
10468 log global
10469 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10470
10471 # log the name of the virtual server
10472 capture request header Host len 20
10473
10474 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10475 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10476
10477 # log the beginning of the referrer
10478 capture request header Referer len 20
10479
10480 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10481 capture response header Server len 20
10482
10483 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10484 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10485
10486 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10487 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10488
10489 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10490 capture response header Via len 20
10491
10492 # log the URL location during a redirection
10493 capture response header Location len 20
10494
10495 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10496 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10497 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10498 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10499 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10500
10501 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10502 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10503 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10504 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010505 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010506
10507 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10508 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10509 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10510 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10511 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010512 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010513
10514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105158.9. Examples of logs
10516---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010517
10518These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10519them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10520reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10521
10522 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10523 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10524 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10525
10526 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10527 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10528
10529 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10530 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10531 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10532
10533 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10534 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10535
10536 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10537 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10538 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10539
10540 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010541 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010542 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10543 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10544
10545 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10546 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10547 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10548
10549 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10550 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010551 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010552 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10553 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10554 to return the 502 and not the server.
10555
10556 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010557 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010558
10559 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10560 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10561 Nothing was sent to any server.
10562
10563 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10564 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10565
10566 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10567 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10568 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10569 send a 408 return code to the client.
10570
10571 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10572 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10573
10574 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10575 5 seconds ("c----").
10576
10577 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10578 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010579 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010580
10581 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010582 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010583 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10584 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10585 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10586 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10587 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010588
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105909. Statistics and monitoring
10591----------------------------
10592
10593It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10594mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10595CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10596Unix socket.
10597
10598
105999.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010600---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010601
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010602The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10603page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010605 0. pxname: proxy name
10606 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10607 for server)
10608 2. qcur: current queued requests
10609 3. qmax: max queued requests
10610 4. scur: current sessions
10611 5. smax: max sessions
10612 6. slim: sessions limit
10613 7. stot: total sessions
10614 8. bin: bytes in
10615 9. bout: bytes out
10616 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010617 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010618 12. ereq: request errors
10619 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010620 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010621 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10622 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010623 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010624 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10625 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10626 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10627 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10628 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10629 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10630 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10631 25. qlimit: queue limit
10632 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10633 27. iid: unique proxy id
10634 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10635 29. throttle: warm up status
10636 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10637 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010638 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010639 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10640 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10641 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010642 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010643 UNK -> unknown
10644 INI -> initializing
10645 SOCKERR -> socket error
10646 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10647 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10648 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10649 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10650 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10651 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10652 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10653 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10654 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10655 disable-on-404
10656 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10657 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10658 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010659 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10660 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010661 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10662 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10663 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10664 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10665 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10666 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010667 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10668 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10669 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10670 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010671 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10672 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010673
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106759.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010676-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010677
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010678The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010679must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10680is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10681a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10682risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10683followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10684given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10685then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10686to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010687
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010688It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10689on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10690own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010691
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010692clear counters
10693 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10694 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10695 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10696 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10697 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10698
10699clear counters all
10700 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10701 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10702 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10703
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010704clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10705 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10706
10707 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10708 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10709 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10710 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10711 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10712 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10713
10714 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10715
10716 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10717 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10718 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10719 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10720 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10721 the ACLs :
10722
10723 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10724 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10725 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10726 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10727 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10728 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10729
10730 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010731 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10732 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010733
10734 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010735 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010736 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010737 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10738 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10739 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10740 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010741
10742 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10743
10744 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010745 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010746 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10747 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010748 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10749 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10750 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010751
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010752disable frontend <frontend>
10753 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10754 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10755 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10756 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10757 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10758 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10759 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10760 on the stats page.
10761
10762 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10763 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10764
10765 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10766 level "admin".
10767
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768disable server <backend>/<server>
10769 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10770 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10771 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10772 during the maintenance.
10773
10774 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10775 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10776
10777 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010778 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010779
10780 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10781 level "admin".
10782
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010783enable frontend <frontend>
10784 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10785 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10786 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10787 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10788 which was disabled.
10789
10790 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10791 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10792
10793 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10794 level "admin".
10795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796enable server <backend>/<server>
10797 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10798 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10799
10800 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010801 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010802
10803 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10804 level "admin".
10805
10806get weight <backend>/<server>
10807 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10808 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10809 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10810 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10811 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010812 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010814help
10815 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10816 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010817
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010818prompt
10819 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10820 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10821 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10822 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10823 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10824 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10825 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10826 command.
10827
10828quit
10829 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010830
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010831set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020010832 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
10833 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
10834 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
10835 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
10836 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010837 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10838 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10839
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010840set maxconn global <maxconn>
10841 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10842 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10843 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10844 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10845 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10846 setting.
10847
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010848set rate-limit connections global <value>
10849 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10850 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10851 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10852 is passed in number of connections per second.
10853
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010854set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10855 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10856 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10857 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10858 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10859 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10860
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010861set timeout cli <delay>
10862 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10863 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10864 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10865
10866set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10867 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10868 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10869 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10870 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10871 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10872 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10873 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10874 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10875 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10876 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10877 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10878 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10879 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010880 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010881
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010882show errors [<iid>]
10883 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10884 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010885 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10886 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10887 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010888
10889 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10890 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10891 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10892 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10893 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10894 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10895 are reported too.
10896
10897 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10898 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10899 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10900 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10901 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10902 code.
10903
10904 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10905 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10906 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10907 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10908 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10909 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10910 line.
10911
10912 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010913 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10914 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010915 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10916 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10917
10918 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10919 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10920 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10921 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10922 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10923 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10924 00204+ minal\r\n
10925 00211 \r\n
10926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010927 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010928 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10929 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10930 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10931 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10932 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10933 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010934
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010935show info
10936 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10937
10938show sess
10939 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010940 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10941 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10942
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010943show sess <id>
10944 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10945 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10946 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10947 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10948 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10949 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010950
10951show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10952 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10953 possible to dump only selected items :
10954 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10955 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10956 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10957 for example:
10958 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10959 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10960 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10961
10962 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010963 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10964 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010965 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10966 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10967 Nbproc: 1
10968 Process_num: 1
10969 (...)
10970
10971 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10972 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10973 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10974 (...)
10975 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10976
10977 $
10978
10979 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10980 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10981 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10982 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010983 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010984
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010985show table
10986 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10987 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10988 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10989 entries currently in use.
10990
10991 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010992 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010993 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10994 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010995
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010996show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010997 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10998 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10999 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011000 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11001
11002 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11003 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11004 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11005 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11006 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11007
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011008 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11009 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11010 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11011 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11012 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11013 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11014
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011015
11016 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011017 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11018 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011019
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011020 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011021 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011022 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011023 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11024 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11025 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11026 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011027
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011028 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011029 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011030 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11031 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011032
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011033 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11034 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011035 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011036 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11037 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011038
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011039 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11040 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011041 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011042 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11043 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11044
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011045 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11046 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11047 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11048 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11049 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11050
11051 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11052 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11053 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011054 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11055 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011056 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11057 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011058
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011059shutdown frontend <frontend>
11060 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11061 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11062 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11063 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11064 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11065 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11066 once it is terminated.
11067
11068 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11069 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11070
11071 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11072 level "admin".
11073
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011074shutdown session <id>
11075 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11076 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11077 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11078 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11079 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11080 flag in the logs.
11081
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011082shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11083 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11084 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11085 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11086 'K' flag in the logs.
11087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011088/*
11089 * Local variables:
11090 * fill-column: 79
11091 * End:
11092 */